Operating Instructions
audio/video multi-channel receiver
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
FEDERAL COMMUNICATIONS COMMISSION DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This
device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired operation.
Product Name: AUDIO/VIDEO MULTI-CHANNEL RECEIVER
Model Number: SC-1525-K
Responsible Party Name: PIONEER ELECTRONICS (USA) INC.
SERVICE SUPPORT DIVISION
Address: 1925 E. DOMINGUEZ ST. LONG BEACH, CA 90810-1003, U.S.A.
Phone: 1-800-421-1404
URL: http://www.pioneerelectronics.com
D8-10-4*_C1_En
NOTE:
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15
of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a
residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed
and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However,
there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause
harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on,
the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures:
— Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
— Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
— Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected.
— Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
D8-10-1-2_A1_En
IMPORTANT NOTICE
Information to User
THE MODEL NUMBER AND SERIAL NUMBER OF
THIS EQUIPMENT ARE ON THE REAR OR BOTTOM.
RECORD THESE NUMBERS ON YOUR ENCLOSED
Alterations or modifications carried out without
appropriate authorization may invalidate the user’s
right to operate the equipment.
D8-10-2_A1_En
WARRANTY PAGE 115 FOR FUTURE REFERENCE.
D36-AP9-1_A1_En
CAUTION
This product satisfies FCC regulations when shielded
cables and connectors are used to connect the unit
to other equipment. To prevent electromagnetic
interference with electric appliances such as radios
and televisions, use shielded cables and connectors
If the AC plug of this unit does not match the AC
outlet you want to use, the plug must be removed
and appropriate one fitted. Replacement and
mounting of an AC plug on the power supply cord of
this unit should be performed only by qualified
service personnel. If connected to an AC outlet, the
cut-off plug can cause severe electrical shock. Make
sure it is properly disposed of after removal.
for connections.
D8-10-3a_A1_En
The equipment should be disconnected by removing
the mains plug from the wall socket when left unused
for a long period of time (for example, when on
VENTILATION CAUTION
When installing this unit, make sure to leave space
around the unit for ventilation to improve heat radiation
(at least 20 cm at top, 10 cm at rear, and 20 cm at each
side).
vacation).
D3-4-2-2-1a_A1_En
WARNING
CAUTION
Slots and openings in the cabinet are provided for
ventilation to ensure reliable operation of the product,
and to protect it from overheating. To prevent fire
hazard, the openings should never be blocked or
covered with items (such as newspapers, table-cloths,
curtains) or by operating the equipment on thick carpet
The STANDBY/ON switch on this unit will not
completely shut off all power from the AC outlet.
Since the power cord serves as the main disconnect
device for the unit, you will need to unplug it from the
AC outlet to shut down all power. Therefore, make
sure the unit has been installed so that the power
cord can be easily unplugged from the AC outlet in
case of an accident. To avoid fire hazard, the power
cord should also be unplugged from the AC outlet
when left unused for a long period of time (for
or a bed.
D3-4-2-1-7b*_A1_En
example, when on vacation).
D3-4-2-2-2a*_A1_En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
This product is for general household purposes. Any
failure due to use for other than household purposes
(such as long-term use for business purposes in a
restaurant or use in a car or ship) and which requires
repair will be charged for even during the warranty
period.
K041_A1_En
The Safety of Your Ears is in Your Hands
Get the most out of your equipment by playing it at a
safe level – a level that lets the sound come through
clearly without annoying blaring or distortion and, most
importantly, without affecting your sensitive hearing.
Sound can be deceiving. Over time, your hearing
“comfort level” adapts to higher volumes of sound, so
what sounds “normal” can actually be loud and
harmful to your hearing. Guard against this by setting
your equipment at a safe level BEFORE your hearing
adapts.
ESTABLISH A SAFE LEVEL:
• Set your volume control at a low setting.
• Slowly increase the sound until you can hear it
comfortably and clearly, without distortion.
• Once you have established a comfortable sound
level, set the dial and leave it there.
BE SURE TO OBSERVE THE FOLLOWING
GUIDELINES:
• Do not turn up the volume so high that you can’t
hear what’s around you.
• Use caution or temporarily discontinue use in
potentially hazardous situations.
• Do not use headphones while operating a motorized
vehicle; the use of headphones may create a traffic
hazard and is illegal in many areas.
S001a_A1_En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Thank you for buying this Pioneer product. Please read through these operating instructions so you will know how to operate
your model properly. After you have finished reading the instructions, put them away in a safe place for future reference.
Contents
Connecting an HDMI-equipped component to the
front panel input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Connecting an XM Radio tuner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Connecting a SiriusConnect™ tuner . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Connecting an iPod. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Connecting a USB device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Connecting a USB device for Advanced MCACC
01 Before you start
Our philosophy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Checking what’s in the box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Installing the receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Loading the batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Operating range of remote control unit . . . . . . . . . . . 10
output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Connecting an IR receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Operating other Pioneer components with this
unit’s sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Switching components on and off using the
02 Controls and displays
Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
12 volt trigger. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Plugging in the receiver. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
03 Connecting your equipment
Rear panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Determining the speakers’ application . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Other speaker connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Placing the speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
THX speaker system setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Some tips for improving sound quality . . . . . . . . . . 18
Connecting the speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Installing your speaker system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Standard surround connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Bi-amping your speakers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Bi-wiring your speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Selecting the Speaker system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Front height setup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Front wide setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Speaker B setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Bi-Amping setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
ZONE 2 setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
About the audio connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
About the video converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
About HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Connecting your TV and playback components . . . . . 24
Connecting using HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Connecting your DVD player with no HDMI
output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Connecting your TV with no HDMI input . . . . . . . . . 26
Connecting an HDD/DVD recorder, BD recorder
and other video sources. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Connecting a satellite/cable receiver or other
set-top box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Connecting the multichannel analog inputs . . . . . . . 29
Connecting other audio components. . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
About the WMA9 Pro decoder. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Connecting additional amplifiers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Connecting AM/FM antennas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Connecting external antennas. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
MULTI-ZONE setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Making MULTI-ZONE connections. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Connecting to the network through LAN interface. . . 33
Connecting Optional Bluetooth® ADAPTER . . . . . . . 34
04 Basic Setup
Changing the OSD display language
(OSD Language) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Automatically conducting optimum sound tuning
(Full Auto MCACC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Problems when using the Auto MCACC Setup . . . . 40
The Input Setup menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Input function default and possible settings . . . . . . 41
05 Basic playback
Playing a source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Playing a source with HDMI connection . . . . . . . . . 42
Selecting the multichannel analog inputs. . . . . . . . 42
Playing an iPod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Playing back audio files stored on an iPod . . . . . . . 43
Playing a USB device. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Playing back audio files stored on a USB memory
device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Playing back photo files stored on a USB memory
device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
About playable file formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Listening to the radio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Improving FM sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Using the noise cut mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Using Neural Surround . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Tuning directly to a station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Saving station presets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Listening to station presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Naming station presets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Listening to Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Listening to XM Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Using XM HD Surround . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Saving channel presets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Using the XM Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Listening to SIRIUS Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Saving channel presets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Using the SIRIUS Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Listening to Internet radio stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Programming the Internet radio stations . . . . . . . . 50
5
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Bluetooth ADAPTER for Wireless Enjoyment of
Music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Wireless music play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Pairing the Bluetooth ADAPTER and Bluetooth
wireless technology device. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Listening to music contents of a Bluetooth
09 Controlling the rest of your system
About the Remote Setup menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Operating multiple receivers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Setting the remote to control other components . . . . 68
Selecting preset codes directly. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Programming signals from other remote controls . . . 68
Erasing one of the remote control button settings . . . 69
Erasing all learnt settings that are in one input
wireless technology device with your system . . . . . . 52
function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Direct function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Setting the backlight mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Multi operation and System off. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Programming a Multi operation or a shutdown
sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Using multi operations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Using System off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Erasing the settings for the multi-operation . . . . . . . 71
Resetting the remote control settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Default preset codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Controlling components. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
06 Listening to your system
Auto playback. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Listening in surround sound. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Standard surround sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Using the Home THX modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Using the Advanced surround effects . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Listening in stereo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Using Front Stage Surround Advance . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Using Stream Direct. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Selecting MCACC presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Choosing the input signal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Better sound using Phase Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
10 The Advanced MCACC menu
07 Control with HDMI function
Making receiver settings from the Advanced
Making Control with HDMI connections. . . . . . . . . . . 57
HDMI Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Before using synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
About synchronized operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
About connections with a product of a different brand
that supports the Control with HDMI function . . . . . 59
Setting the PQLS function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Cautions on the Control with HDMI function . . . . . . . 59
MCACC menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Automatic MCACC (Expert) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Manual MCACC setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Fine Channel Level. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Fine Speaker Distance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Standing Wave. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Acoustic Calibration EQ Adjust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Acoustic Calibration EQ Professional . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Checking MCACC Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Speaker Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Channel Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Speaker Distance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Standing Wave. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Acoustic Cal EQ. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Output MCACC data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Data Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Renaming MCACC presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Copying MCACC preset data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Clearing MCACC presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
08 Using other functions
Setting the Audio options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Setting the Video options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Switching the speaker terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Using the MULTI-ZONE controls. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Making an audio or a video recording. . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Reducing the level of an analog signal . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Using the sleep timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Dimming the display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Switching the HDMI output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Using the Web Control function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Checking your system settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Resetting the system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Default system settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
6
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
11 The System Setup and Other Setup menus
Making receiver settings from the System Setup
menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Manual speaker setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Speaker system setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Speaker Setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Channel Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Speaker Distance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
X-Curve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
THX Audio Setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Network Setup menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
IP address/Proxy setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Checking the MAC address. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Network Standby. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
The Other Setup menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Volume Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Remote Control Mode Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Flicker Reduction Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
EXTENSION Setup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Multi Channel Input Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
12 Additional information
Speaker Setting Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Positional relationship between speakers and
monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Troubleshooting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
No sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Other audio problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
ADAPTER PORT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Video. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Professional Calibration EQ graphical output . . . . . 96
Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Web Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Important information regarding the HDMI
connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
USB interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Internet radio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
XM radio messages. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
SIRIUS radio messages. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Surround sound formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Dolby. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
DTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Windows Media Audio 9 Professional . . . . . . . . . . 103
About THX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
About iPod. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
About SIRIUS and XM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Auto Surround, ALC and Stream Direct with
different input signal formats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Preset code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Cleaning the unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
7
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Flow of settings on the receiver
The unit is a full-fledged AV receiver equipped with an abundance of functions and terminals. It can be used easily
after following the procedure below to make the connections and settings.
The colors of the steps indicate the following:
Required setting item
Setting to be made as necessary
MCACC speaker settings
• Automatically conducting optimum sound tuning
(Full Auto MCACC) (page 38)
1
2
Before you start
• Checking what’s in the box (page 10)
• Loading the batteries (page 10)
7
8
9
Determining the speakers’ application (page
17)
The Input Setup menu (page 40)
• 7.1 channel surround system (Front height)
• 7.1 channel surround system (Front wide)
• 7.1 channel surround system & Speaker B
connection
• 5.1 channel surround system & Front Bi-amping
connection (High quality surround)
(When using connections other than the
recommended connections)
Basic playback (page 42)
• 5.1 channel surround system & ZONE 2 connection
(Multi Zone)
10 Switching the HDMI output (page 65)
11 Adjusting the sound and picture quality as desired
• Using the various listening modes (page 53)
• Better sound using Phase Control (page 56)
• Measuring the all EQ type (SYMMETRY/ALL CH
ADJ/FRONT ALIGN) (page 75)
• Changing the channel level while listening (Tip on
page 86)
• Switching on/off the Acoustic Calibration EQ,
Sound retriever or Dialog Enhancement (page 60)
• Setting the PQLS function (page 59)
• Setting the Audio options (Tone, Loudness or
Sound delay, etc.) (page 60)
• Setting the Video options (page 62)
3
4
Connecting the speakers
• Placing the speakers (page 18)
• Connecting the speakers (page 19)
• Installing your speaker system (page 20)
• Bi-amping your speakers (page 21)
Connecting the components
• About the audio connection (page 22)
• About the video converter (page 22)
• Connecting your TV and playback components
(page 24)
• Connecting AM/FM antennas (page 31)
• Plugging in the receiver (page 37)
12 Other optional adjustments and settings
• Control with HDMI function (page 57)
• The Advanced MCACC menu (page 75)
• The System Setup and Other Setup menus (page
84)
5
6
Power On
Changing the OSD display language (OSD
Language) (page 38)
13 Making maximum use of the remote control
• Operating multiple receivers (page 67)
• Setting the remote to control other components
(page 68)
8
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Before you start
01
Chapter 1:
Before you start
•
PQLS1
Jitterless high quality playback is possible by connecting
a PQLS-compatible player with HDMI connections.
Our philosophy
Pioneer is dedicated to making your home theater
listening experience as close as possible to the vision of
the moviemakers and mastering engineer when they
created the original soundtrack. We do this by focusing
on three important steps:
•
Dolby Pro Logic llz compatible
Adding a pair of speakers above the front left and right
speakers adds expressiveness in the vertical direction to the
previous horizontally-oriented sound field. The height
channel strengthens the sound field’s sense of three-
dimensionality and air, producing presence and expansion.
1
Achieving the highest possible sound quality
2
Allowing for customized acoustic calibration
•
Internet Radio
according to any listening area
By connecting this receiver to the network via the LAN
terminal, you can listen to Internet radio stations.
3
Fine-tuning the receiver with the help of world-
class studio engineers*
•
XM and SIRIUS Ready
* With the cooperation of AIR Studios, this receiver has
been designated AIR Studios Monitor:
With the XM and SIRIUS Radio terminals, you’ll be up
and running in no time.
•
Bluetooth compatible
Using the Bluetooth ADAPTER (Pioneer Model No. AS-
2
BT100) lets you enjoy music files on an iPhone or other
Bluetooth wireless technology device wirelessly.
•
Sound Retriever and Sound Retriever Air
The Sound Retriever feature employs DSP technology to
restore sound pressure and smooth jagged artifacts left
over after compression. Sound Retriever Air
compensates for reduced sound quality due to
compression when sending Bluetooth signals.
Features
•
Direct Energy HD Amplifier
Through a collaboration, Pioneer and ICEpower have
jointly development a unique class D amplifier called a
“Direct Energy HD (High Fidelity Class D) amplifier”. This
new generation reference amplifier offers outstanding
performance with high sound quality and reproduces the
latest in multi-channel digital contents.
•
Easy setup using Advanced MCACC
The Auto MCACC Setup provides a quick but accurate
surround sound setup, which includes the advanced
features of Professional Acoustic Calibration EQ.
•
Web control
•
HDMI (Ver.1.4a with 3D, Audio Return Channel)
The receiver can be operated using a browser from a
computer connected on the same LAN as the receiver.
A compatible component is required to use the above
function.
•
RF two-way communications function
3
•
Remote operation on an iPhone/iPod touch
Using the CU-RF100 , the information shown of the
receiver’s display can be displayed on the remote control
in your hands and you can operate the remote control
without worrying about obstacles or the direction in
which the remote control is pointing.
Operation via LAN is possible from an iPhone or iPod
touch by downloading a Pioneer original application
(iControlAV) from the iTunes Store.
•
iPhone/iPod playback
Your iPhone or iPod can be connected to the receiver’s
USB terminal to play the music/video files on the iPhone/
iPod.
Note
1 The PQLS functions supported for the PQLS Multi Surround and PQLS 2ch Audio.
2 The AS-BT100 is sold separately.
3 The CU-RF100 is sold separately.
9
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Before you start
01
• Never use new and old batteries together.
• Insert the plus and minus sides of the batteries
properly according to the marks in the battery case.
Checking what’s in the box
Please check that you’ve received the following supplied
accessories:
• Batteries with the same shape may have different
voltages. Do not use different batteries together.
• Setup microphone (cable: 5 m (16.4 ft.))
• When disposing of used batteries, please comply
with governmental regulations or environmental
public instruction’s rules that apply in your country or
area.
• Remote control unit
• AAA size IEC R03 dry cell batteries (to confirm system
operation) x2
• AM loop antenna
• FM wire antenna
• iPod cable
• WARNING
Do not use or store batteries in direct sunlight or
other excessively hot place, such as inside a car or
near a heater. This can cause batteries to leak,
overheat, explode or catch fire. It can also reduce the
life or performance of batteries.
• Power cord
• These operating instructions
Installing the receiver
Operating range of remote control unit
• When installing this unit, make sure to put it on a
The remote control may not work properly if:
level and stable surface.
• There are obstacles between the remote control and
the receiver’s remote sensor.
Don’t install it on the following places:
– on a color TV (the screen may distort)
– near a cassette deck (or close to a device that gives off
a magnetic field). This may interfere with the sound.
– in direct sunlight
• Direct sunlight or fluorescent light is shining onto the
remote sensor.
• The receiver is located near a device that is emitting
infrared rays.
– in damp or wet areas
– in extremely hot or cold areas
– in places where there is vibration or other movement
– in places that are very dusty
• The receiver is operated simultaneously with another
infrared remote control unit.
– in places that have hot fumes or oils (such as a kitchen)
• Do not touch this receiver’s bottom panel while the
power is on or just after it is turned off. The bottom
panel becomes hot when the power is on (or right
after it is turned off) and could cause burns.
30°
30°
Loading the batteries
7 m (23 ft.)
The batteries included with the unit are to check initial
operations; they may not last over a long period.
We recommend using alkaline batteries that have a
longer life.
Tip
• By connecting an RF adapter to the RS-232C and
EXTENSION terminals, the CU-RF100 omni-
directional remote control can be used for RF two-
1
way communications with the receiver. With RF two-
way communications, the information of the
receiver’s display can be displayed on the remote
control in your hands and the remote control can be
operated without worrying about obstacles or the
CAUTION
2
direction in which the remote control is pointing.
Incorrect use of batteries may result in such hazards as
leakage and bursting. Observe the following precautions:
Note
1 The RF adapter and CU-RF100 omni-directional remote control are sold separately.
2 The maximum line-of-sight distance for RF two-way communications is about 10 meters. This line-of-sight communications distance is a rough
indication, and may differ according to the surrounding environment.
10
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controls and displays
02
Chapter 2:
Controls and displays
The remote has been conveniently color-coded according
to component control using the following system:
Remote control
• White – Receiver control, TV control
This section explains how to operate the remote control
for the receiver.
• Blue – Other controls (See page 43, 44, 46, 47, 51 and
72.)
10
1
RECEIVER
MULTI
RECEIVER
SOURCE
OPERATION
This switches between standby and on for this receiver.
1
2
R.SETUP
2
MULTI OPERATION – Use to perform multi
operations (page 70).
R.SETUP – Use to input the preset code when making
remote control settings and to set the remote control
mode (page 67).
BD
TV
DVD DVR/BDR HDMI
CD NET RADIO ADAPTER
3
iPod USB TUNER SIRIUS
INPUT SELECT TV CTRL
XM
RECEIVER
3
Input function buttons
11
Press to select control of other components (page 67).
4
5
MASTER
VOLUME
INPUT
Use INPUT SELECT to select the input function (page 42).
TV CONTROL
12
13
4
TV CTRL
CH
VOL
MUTE
Set the preset code of your TV’s manufacturer when
controlling the TV (page 68).
AUDIO
VIDEO
PARAMETER
PARAMETER
5
TV CONTROL buttons
LIST TUNE TOOLS
6
7
These buttons are dedicated to control the TV assigned to
the TV CTRL button.
TOP MENU
BAND
T.EDIT
GUIDE
PRESET
ENTER
PRESET
6
Receiver setting buttons
CATEGORY
RETURN
Press first to access:
RECEIVER
HOME
TUNE
MENU
AUDIO PARAMETER – Use to access the Audio
options (page 60).
iPod CTRL
AUTO /ALC
/
PGM MEMORY MENU
DIRECT STEREO STANDARD ADV SURR
HDD
DVD
VIDEO PARAMETER – Use to access the Video
THX
PHASE CTRL
STATUS
options (page 62).
TV
/
DTV
MPX
PQLS
HOME MENU – Use to access the Home Menu
(pages 38, 40, 57, 75, 84 and 87).
8
9
HDMI OUT
2
AUDIO
1
3
RETURN – Press to confirm and exit the current
menu screen.
SIGNAL SEL MCACC SLEEP
INFO
DISP
4
5
6
CH LEVEL A.ATT DIMMER
7
////ENTER
7
8
9
CH
Use the arrow buttons when setting up your surround
sound system (see page 75) and the Audio or Video
options (page 60 or 62).
D.ACCESS
CLASS
ENTER
/
CLR
0
ZONE 2
ZONE 3
LIGHT
14
8
Receiver Control buttons
Press first to access:
RECEIVER
AUTO/ALC/DIRECT – Switches between Auto
Surround (page 53), Auto Level Control mode and
Stream Direct mode (page 55).
RECEIVER
STEREO – Switches between stereo playback and
Front Stage Surround Advance modes (page 55).
11
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controls and displays
02
STANDARD – Press for Standard decoding and to
switch various modes (2 Pro Logic, Neo:6, etc.)
(page 53).
DIMMER – Dims or brightens the display (page 65).
9
MULTI-ZONE select buttons
Switch to perform operations in ZONE 2 and ZONE 3
(page 64).
ADV SURR – Use to switch between the various
surround modes (page 54).
10 Remote control LED
Lights when a command is sent from the remote control.
THX – Press to select a Home THX listening mode
(page 54).
RECEIVER
11
PHASE CTRL – Press to switch on/off Phase Control
Switches the remote to control the receiver (used to
select the white commands).
(page 56).
STATUS – Press to check selected receiver settings
(page 65).
Switch to perform operations in the main zone.
Also use this button to set up surround sound.
PQLS – Press to select the PQLS setting (page 59).
HDMI OUT – Switch the HDMI output terminal
(page 65).
12 MASTER VOLUME +/–
Use to set the listening volume.
SIGNAL SEL – Use to select an input signal (page 56).
13 MUTE
MCACC – Press to switch between MCACC presets
(page 56).
Mutes the sound or restores the sound if it has been
muted (adjusting the volume also restores the sound).
SLEEP – Use to put the receiver in sleep mode and
select the amount of time before sleep (page 65).
14
Press to turn on/off the illumination for the buttons. The
way the buttons light can be selected from four modes
(page 70).
CH LEVEL – Press repeatedly to select a channel,
then use / to adjust the level (page 86).
A.ATT – Attenuates (lowers) the level of an analog
input signal to prevent distortion (page 64).
Display
6
1
2
3
4
5
7 8
9
10
11
12 13
2
DIGITAL PLUS
DSD PCM
TUNED
AUTO
PCM
HDMI
DIGITAL
ANALOG
L
C
R
2
TrueHD WMA9Pro MULTI-ZONE PQLS ALC ATT STEREO
SL
SR
DTS HD ES 96/24
MONO
S.RTRV SOUND UP MIX OVER
dB
XL XC XR
TV
DVD
BD DVR
SIRIUS
iPod
CD TUNER
CD-R PHONO
VIDEO
HDMI [ 2 ]
USB XM
[ 3 ]
MSTR
LFE
[ 4 ]
AUTO SURROUND
STREAM DIRECT
2
PROLOGIC
x
Neo:6
THX ADV.SURROUND
STEREO STANDARD
SP AB
SLEEP
6
14
15 16 17
18
19
1
SIGNAL indicators
3
Digital format indicators
Light to indicate the currently selected input signal.
AUTO lights when the receiver is set to select the input
Light when a signal encoded in the corresponding format
is detected.
signal automatically (page 56).
2 DIGITAL – Lights with Dolby Digital decoding.
2 DIGITAL PLUS – Lights with Dolby Digital Plus
decoding.
2 TrueHD – Lights with Dolby TrueHD decoding.
DTS – Lights with DTS decoding.
2
Program format indicators
Light to indicate the channels to which digital signals are
being input.
L/R – Left front/Right front channel
DTS HD – Lights with DTS-HD decoding.
96/24 – Lights with DTS 96/24 decoding.
WMA9 Pro – Lights to indicate that a WMA9 Pro
signal is being decoded.
DSD PCM – Light during DSD (Direct Stream Digital)
to PCM conversion with SACDs.
C – Center channel
SL/SR – Left surround/Right surround channel
LFE – Low frequency effects channel (the (( )) indicators light
when an LFE signal is being input)
XL/XR – Two channels other than the ones above
XC – Either one channel other than the ones above, the mono
surround channel or matrix encode flag
12
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controls and displays
02
PCM – Lights during playback of PCM signals.
MSTR – Lights during playback of DTS-HD Master
Audio signals.
14 Speaker indicators
Lights to indicate the current speaker system, A and/or B
(page 63).
15 SLEEP
4
MULTI-ZONE
Lights when the receiver is in sleep mode (page 65).
Lights when the MULTI-ZONE feature is active (page 63).
16 Matrix decoding format indicators
5
SOUND
2PRO LOGIC IIx – This lights to indicate 2 Pro
Logic II / 2 Pro Logic IIx decoding (page 53).
Lights when any of the Midnight, Loudness or tone
controls features is selected (page 60).
Neo:6 – When one of the Neo:6 modes of the receiver
is on, this lights to indicate Neo:6 processing (page 53)
Lights when Dialog Enhancement is switched on.
.
6
Listening mode indicators
17 S.RTRV
AUTO SURROUND – Lights when the Auto Surround
feature is switched on (page 53).
Lights when the Sound Retriever function is active
(page 60)
.
ALC – Lights when the ALC (Auto level control) mode
is selected (page 55).
18 Character display
Displays various system information.
STREAM DIRECT – Lights when Direct/Pure Direct is
selected (page 55).
19 Remote control mode indicator
Lights to indicate the receiver’s remote control mode
setting. (Not displayed when set to 1.) (page 67)
ADV.SURROUND – Lights when one of the
Advanced Surround modes has been selected
(page 54).
STEREO – Lights when stereo listening is switched
on (page 55).
STANDARD – Lights when one of the Standard
Surround modes is switched on (page 53).
THX – Lights when one of the Home THX modes is
selected (page 54).
7
(PHASE CONTROL)
Lights when the Phase Control is switched on (page 56).
8
Analog signal indicators
Light to indicate reducing the level of an analog signal
(page 64).
9
Tuner indicators
TUNED – Lights when a broadcast is being received.
STEREO – Lights when a stereo FM broadcast is being
received in auto stereo mode.
MONO – Lights when the mono mode is set using
MPX.
10
Lights when the sound is muted (page 12).
11 Master volume level
Shows the overall volume level.
“---” indicates the minimum level, and “+12dB” indicates
the maximum level.
12 Input function indicators
Light to indicate the input function you have selected.
13 Scroll indicators
Light when there are more selectable items when making
the various settings.
13
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controls and displays
Front panel
02
1
2
3 4
5
6
INPUT
SELECTOR
MASTER
VOLUME
ADVANCED
MCACC
iPod
iPhone
PQLS
HDMI
STANDBY/ON
8
9 10 11 12
13
14
15
AUDIO
PARAMETER
(TUNE)
VIDEO
CONTROL ON/OFF
MULTI-ZONE
TUNER EDIT
BAND AUTO SURR/ALC/ HOME STANDARD ADVANCED STEREO
SPEAKERS
STREAM DIRECT THX
SURROUND SURROUND
(PRESET)
ENTER
(TUNE)
(PRESET)
7
iPod
iPhone
HDMI 5
VIDEO CAMERA
USB
MCACC
SETUP MIC
PHONES
HOME MENU
RETURN
16
STANDBY/ON
17
18
19
20
21
1
7
Front panel controls
Switches the receiver between on and standby.
To access the front panel controls, push gently on the
lower third portion of the panel with your finger.
2
INPUT SELECTOR dial
Use to select an input function.
3
Indicators
ADVANCED MCACC
–
Lights when EQ is set to ON in
the AUDIO PARAMETER menu (page 60)
.
PQLS – Lights when the PQLS feature is active
(page 59).
HDMI – Blinks when connecting an HDMI-equipped
component; lights when the component is connected
8
AUDIO PARAMETER
(page 24)
.
Use to access the Audio options (page 60).
iPod/iPhone – Lights to indicate iPod/iPhone is
connected (page 35).
9
VIDEO PARAMETER
Use to access the Video options (page 62).
4
Remote sensor
Receives the signals from the remote control (see
Operating range of remote control unit on page 10).
10 /// TUNE PRESET) /ENTER
(
/
Use the arrow buttons when setting up your Home
Menu. Use TUNE / to find radio frequencies and use
PRESET / to find preset stations (page 46).
5
Character display
See Display on page 12.
6
MASTER VOLUME dial
14
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controls and displays
02
11 TUNER EDIT
Use with ////ENTER to memorize and name
stations for recall (page 46).
12 BAND
Switches between AM and FM radio bands (page 46).
13 Listening mode buttons
AUTO SURR/ALC/STREAM DIRECT – Switches
between Auto Surround (page 53), Auto Level Control
mode and Stream Direct mode (page 55)
.
HOME THX – Press to select a Home THX listening
mode (page 54).
STANDARD SURROUND – Press for Standard
decoding and to switch various modes (2 Pro Logic,
Neo:6, etc.) (page 53).
ADVANCED SURROUND – Use to switch between
the various surround modes (page 54).
STEREO – Switches between stereo playback and
Front Stage Surround Advance modes (page 55).
14 MULTI-ZONE controls
If you’ve made MULTI-ZONE connections (see MULTI-
ZONE setup on page 32) use these controls to control the
sub zone from the main zone (see Using the MULTI-ZONE
controls on page 63).
15 SPEAKERS
Use to change the speaker terminal (page 63).
16 HOME MENU
Press to access the Home Menu (pages 38, 40, 57, 75, 84
and 87).
17 RETURN
Press to confirm and exit the current menu screen.
18 HDMI input connector
Use for connection to a compatible HDMI device (Video
camera, etc.) (page 34).
19 iPod/iPhone/USB terminals
Use to connect your Apple iPod as an audio and video
source, or connect a USB device for audio and photo
playback (page 35).
20 MCACC SETUP MIC jack
Use to connect the supplied microphone (page 38).
21 PHONES jack
Use to connect headphones. When the headphones are
connected, there is no sound output from the speakers.
15
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
CChaoptnern3:ecting your equipment
This receiver provides you with many connection possibilities, but it doesn’t have to be difficult. This chapter explains
the kinds of components you can connect to make up your home theater system.
Rear panel
OUT 1
OUT 2
AC IN
(
)
XM
IN
ADAPTER PORT
OUTPUT 5 V
LAN 10/100
BD
IN
IN
1
IN
2
IN
3
IN
4
(
)
CONTROL
HDMI
(
ASSIGNABLE
)
100 mA MAX
1
4
COMPONENTVIDEO
SIRIUS COAXIAL
OPTICAL
ASSIGNABLE
ASSIGNABLE
ASSIGNABLE
IN IN
(
)
DVD
IN
IN
IN
1
2
3
IN
IN
1
IN
2
1
2
IN
3
MONITOR
OUT
(
)
(
)
(
)
(
)
(
)
DVD
CD
TV/SAT
DVR/BDR
VIDEO
OUT
(
)
DVR/BDR
VIDEO
CD-R/TAPE
IN
ZONE2
OUT
ZONE3
OUT
DVD
IN
TV/SAT
IN
VIDEO
IN
DVR/BDR
OUT IN
PHONO
IN
CD
IN
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK FH/FW
(Single)
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK
L
(
)
OUT
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
ZONE 2 OUT
R
SUBWOOFER
PRE OUT
MULTI CH IN
SUBWOOFER
SIGNAL
Y
PB
PR
GND
ANTENNA
FRONT HEIGHT/WIDE/
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
FRONT
CENTER
B
A
R
L
R
L
(Single)
R
L
R
L
SPEAKERS
Class 2Wiring
AM LOOP
FM UNBAL 75
SELECTABLE
SEE INSTRUCTION
MANUAL
CONTROL
IR
12V
RS-232C
IN
IN
1
TRIGGER
1
2
IN
SELECTABLE
VOIR LE MODE
D'EMPLOI
(OUTPUT
12V
TOTAL
(
OUTPUT 5 V
2
)
150 mA MAX
OUT
150 mA MAX)
CAUTION:
OUT
SPEAKER IMPEDANCE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
EXTENSION
ATTENTION:
ENCEINTE D'IMPEDANCE DE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
• The CU-RF100 omni-directional remote control
(separately sold) can be connected to the RS-232C
and EXTENSION terminals. Using the CU-RF100 lets
you display the receiver’s display information on the
remote control display in your hands and operate it
without worrying about obstacles or the direction in
which the remote control is pointing.
Note
• The input functions below are assigned by default to
the receiver’s different input terminals. Refer to The
Input Setup menu on page 40 to change the
assignments if other connections are used.
Input Terminals
Input function
Digital
HDMI
Component
IN 1
DVD
COAX-1
BD
(BD)
RS-232C
TV/SAT
DVR/BDR
VIDEO
HDMI 1
HDMI 2
HDMI 3
OPT-1
OPT-2
OPT-3
(
OUTPUT 5 V
)
150 mA MAX
IN 2
IN 3
EXTENSION
(HDMI-1)
(HDMI-2)
(HDMI-3)
(HDMI-4)
(HDMI-5)
CAUTION
• Before making or changing the connections, switch
off the power and disconnect the power cord from the
power outlet. Plugging in should be the final step.
HDMI 4
HDMI 5
(front panel)
CD
COAX-2
CD-R/TAPE
16
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
This surround system produces a true-to-life sound over
a wider area.
Determining the speakers’ application
This unit permits you to build various surround systems,
in accordance with the number of speakers you have.
[C] 7.1 channel surround system & Speaker B
connection
• Speaker System setting: Speaker B
• Be sure to connect speakers to the front left and right
channels (L and R).
• It is also possible to only connect one of the surround
back speakers (SB) or neither.
Choose one from Plans [A] to [E] below.
R
[A] 7.1 channel surround system (Front height)
L
*Default setting
R
C
L
SR
• Speaker System setting: Normal(SB/FH)
SW
FHR
SBR
FHL
SL
Speaker B
SBL
R
L
C
SR
With these connections you can simultaneously enjoy
5.1-channel surround sound in the main zone with stereo
playback of the same sound on the B speakers. The same
connections also allow for 7.1-channel surround sound
in the main zone when not using the B speakers.
SW
SL
SBR
SBL
[D] 5.1 channel surround system & Front Bi-
amping connection (High quality surround)
• Speaker System setting: Front Bi-Amp
A 7.1 ch surround system connects the left and right
front speakers (L/R), the center speaker (C), the left and
right front height speakers (FHL/FHR), the left and right
surround speakers (SL/SR), the left and right surround
Bi-amping connection of the front speakers for high
sound quality with 5.1-channel surround sound.
1
back speakers (SBL/SBR), and the subwoofer (SW).
Front Bi-Amp
This surround system produces a more true-to-life sound
from above.
R
[B] 7.1 channel surround system (Front wide)
• Speaker System setting: Normal(SB/FW)
L
C
SW
R
SR
FWR
L
SL
C
SR
SW
FWL
SL
SBR
SBL
This plan replaces the left and right front height speakers
shown in [A] with the left and right front wide speakers
1
(FWL/FWR).
Note
1 It is not possible to produce sound simultaneously from the front height or front wide speakers and the surround back speakers.
17
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
[E] 5.1 channel surround system & ZONE 2
connection (Multi Zone)
• Speaker System setting: ZONE 2
Placing the speakers
Refer to the chart below for placement of the speakers
With these connections you can simultaneously enjoy
5.1-channel surround sound in the main zone with stereo
playback on another component in ZONE 2. (The
selection of input devices is limited.)
you intend to connect.
SW
FHL
L
FHR
R
C
30 30
Main zone
FWL
SL
FWR
SR
R
60
120
60
120
L
C
SW
60
SBL
SB
SBR
SR
Sub zone
SL
• Place the surround speakers at 120º from the center.
If you, (1) use the surround back speaker, and, (2)
don’t use the front height speakers / front wide
speakers, we recommend placing the surround
speaker right beside you.
R
L
ZONE 2
• If you intend to connect only one surround back
speaker, place it directly behind you.
• Place the left and right front height speakers at least
one meter (3.3 ft.) directly above the left and right
front speakers.
Important
• The Speaker System setting must be made if you
use any of the connections shown above other than
[A] (see Speaker system setting on page 85).
THX speaker system setup
If you are using a THX certified subwoofer, use the THX
INPUT jack on the subwoofer (if your subwoofer has one)
or switch the filter position to THX on your subwoofer.
• Sound does not come through simultaneously from
the front height, front wide, speaker B and surround
back speakers. Output speakers are different
See also THX Audio Setting on page 87 to make the
settings that will give you the best sound experience
when using the Home THX modes (page 54).
depending on the input signal or listening mode.
Other speaker connections
Some tips for improving sound quality
• Your favorite speaker connections can be selected
even if you have fewer than 5.1 speakers (except front
left/right speakers).
Where you put your speakers in the room has a big effect
on the quality of the sound. The following guidelines
should help you to get the best sound from your system.
• When not connecting a subwoofer, connect speakers
with low frequency reproduction capabilities to the
front channel. (The subwoofer’s low frequency
component is played from the front speakers, so the
speakers could be damaged.)
• The subwoofer can be placed on the floor. Ideally, the
other speakers should be at about ear-level when
you’re listening to them. Putting the speakers on the
floor (except the subwoofer), or mounting them very
high on a wall is not recommended.
•
After connecting, be sure to conduct the Full Auto
MCACC (speaker environment setting) procedure.
See Automatically conducting optimum sound tuning
(Full Auto MCACC) on page 38.
• For the best stereo effect, place the front speakers 2
m to 3 m (6 ft. to 9 ft.) apart, at equal distance from
the TV.
• If you’re going to place speakers around your CRT TV,
use shielded speakers or place the speakers at a
sufficient distance from your CRT TV.
• If you’re using a center speaker, place the front
speakers at a wider angle. If not, place them at a
narrower angle.
18
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
• Place the center speaker above or below the TV so
that the sound of the center channel is localized at
the TV screen. Also, make sure the center speaker
does not cross the line formed by the leading edge of
the front left and right speakers.
Connecting the speakers
Each speaker connection on the receiver comprises a
positive (+) and negative (–) terminal. Make sure to
match these up with the terminals on the speakers
themselves.
• It is best to angle the speakers towards the listening
position. The angle depends on the size of the room.
Use less of an angle for bigger rooms.
CAUTION
• Surround and surround back speakers should be
positioned 60 cm to 90 cm (2 ft. to 3 ft.) higher than
your ears and tilted slightly downward. Make sure the
speakers don’t face each other. For DVD-Audio, the
speakers should be more directly behind the listener
than for home theater playback.
• These speaker terminals carry HAZARDOUS LIVE
voltage. To prevent the risk of electric shock when
connecting or disconnecting the speaker cables,
disconnect the power cord before touching any
uninsulated parts.
• Make sure that all the bare speaker wire is twisted
together and inserted fully into the speaker terminal.
If any of the bare speaker wire touches the back panel
it may cause the power to cut off as a safety measure.
• Try not to place the surround speakers farther away
from the listening position than the front and center
speakers. Doing so can weaken the surround sound
effect.
Bare wire connections
1
2
3
Twist exposed wire strands together. (fig. A)
Loosen terminal and insert exposed wire. (fig. B)
Tighten terminal. (fig. C)
fig. A
fig. B
fig. C
3
10 mm ( / in.)
8
Banana plug connections
If you want to use speaker cables terminated with banana
plugs, screw the speaker terminal fully shut, then plug
the banana plug into the end of the speaker terminal.
Important
• Please refer to the manual that came with your
speakers for details on how to connect the other end
of the speaker cables to your speakers.
• Use an RCA cable to connect the subwoofer. It is not
possible to connect using speaker cables.
CAUTION
• Make sure that all speakers are securely installed.
This not only improves sound quality, but also
reduces the risk of damage or injury resulting from
speakers being knocked over or falling in the event of
external shocks such as earthquakes.
19
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
Installing your speaker system
03
At the very least, front left and right speakers only are necessary. Note that your main surround speakers should always
be connected as a pair, but you can connect just one surround back speaker if you like (it must be connected to the
left surround back terminal).
Standard surround connection
The front height terminals can also be used
for the front wide and Speaker B speakers.
Front height setting
Front height right
Front height left
Front wide left
Speaker B - left
Front wide setting
Front wide right
Speaker B setting
Speaker B - right
Front right
Front left
Subwoofer
Center
LINE LEVEL
INPUT
OUT 1
OUT 2
AC IN
(
)
XM
IN
ADAPTER PORT
(OUTPUT
100 mA MAX
LAN 10/100
BD
IN
IN
1
IN
2
IN
3
IN
4
(
)
CONTROL
HDMI
5
V
)
ASSIGNABLE
1
4
COMPONENTVIDEO
ASSIGNABLE
SIRIUS COAXIAL
OPTICAL
ASSIGNABLE
IN
ASSIGNABLE
(
)
DVD
IN
IN
IN
1
2
3
IN
IN
1
IN
2
IN
1
2
IN
3
MONITOR
OUT
(
)
(
)
(
)
(
)
(
)
DVD
CD
TV/SAT
DVR/BDR
VIDEO
OUT
(
)
DVR/BDR
VIDEO
CD-R/TAPE
IN
ZONE2
OUT
ZONE3
OUT
DVD
IN
TV/SAT
IN
VIDEO
IN
DVR/BDR
OUT IN
PHONO
IN
CD
IN
FRCENTER SURROUND SURR BACK FH/FW
(Single)
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK
L
(
)
OUT
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
ZONE 2 OUT
R
SUBWOOFER
PRE OUT
MULTI CH IN
SUBWOOFER
SIGNAL
Y
PB
PR
GND
ANTENNA
FRONT HEIGHT/WIDE/
B
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
FRONT
CENTER
A
R
L
R
L
(Single)
R
L
R
L
SPEAKERS
Class 2Wiring
AM LOOP
FM UNBAL 75
SELECTABLE
SEE INSTRUCTION
MANUAL
CONTROL
IR
12V
RS-232C
IN
IN
1
TRIGGER
1
2
IN
SELECTABLE
VOIR LE MODE
D'EMPLOI
(OUTPUT
12V
TOTAL
(
OUTPUT
5
V
)
2
150 mA MAX
OUT
150 mA MAX)
CAUTION:
OUT
SPEAKER IMPEDANCE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
EXTENSION
ATTENTION:
ENCEINTE D'IMPEDANCE DE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
The surround back terminals can also be
used for ZONE 2.
5.1 ch surround setting
Not connected
Not connected
Not connected
Surround back
Surround back left
ZONE 2 - Left
6.1 ch surround setting
Surround right
Surround left
7.1 ch surround setting
Surround back right
ZONE 2 setting
ZONE 2 - Right
20
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
Bi-amping your speakers
Front right
Front left
High
Bi-amp compatible
Bi-amp compatible
speaker
speaker
High
Center
Low
Low
Subwoofer
OUT 1
OUT 2
AC IN
(
)
XM
IN
ADAPTER PORT
LAN 10/100
BD
IN
IN
1
IN
2
IN
3
IN
4
(
)
CONTROL
HDMI
(OUTPUT
5
V
ASSIGNABLE
)
100 mA MAX
1
4
COMPONENTVIDEO
ASSIGNABLE
SIRIUS COAXIAL
OPTICAL
ASSIGNABLE
ASSIGNABLE
(
)
DVD
IN
IN
IN
1
2
3
IN
IN
1
IN
2
IN
1
IN
2
IN
3
MONITOR
OUT
(
)
(
)
(
)
(
)
(
)
DVD
CD
TV/SAT
DVR/BDR
VIDEO
OUT
(
)
DVR/BDR
VIDEO
CD-R/TAPE
IN
ZONE2
OUT
ZONE3
OUT
DVD
IN
TV/SAT
IN
VIDEO
IN
DVR/BDR
OUT IN
PHONO
IN
CD
IN
FROCENTER SURROUND SURR BACK FH/FW
(Single)
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK
(
)
OUT
VIDEO
L
MONITOR OUT
ZONE 2 OUT
R
SUBWOOFER
PRE OUT
MULTI CH IN
SUBWOOFER
SIGNAL
Y
PB
PR
GND
ANTENNA
FRONT HEIGHT/WIDE/
B
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
FRONT
CENTER
A
R
L
R
L
(Single)
R
L
R
L
SPEAKERS
Class 2Wiring
AM LOOP
FM UNBAL 75
SELECTABLE
SEE INSTRUCTION
MANUAL
CONTROL
IR
12V
RS-232C
IN
IN
1
TRIGGER
1
2
IN
SELECTABLE
VOIR LE MODE
D'EMPLOI
(OUTPUT
12V
TOTAL
(
OUTPUT
5
V
)
2
150 mA MAX
OUT
150 mA MAX)
CAUTION:
OUT
SPEAKER IMPEDANCE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
EXTENSION
ATTENTION:
ENCEINTE D'IMPEDANCE DE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
Surround right
Surround left
Bi-amping is when you connect the high frequency driver
and low frequency driver of your speakers to different
amplifiers for better crossover performance. Your
speakers must be bi-ampable to do this (having separate
terminals for high and low) and the sound improvement
will depend on the kind of speakers you’re using.
Bi-wiring your speakers
Your speakers can also be bi-wired if they support bi-
amping.
• With these connections, the Speaker System setting
makes no difference.
•
To bi-wire a speaker, connect two speaker cords to
the speaker terminal on the receiver.
Using a banana plug for the second connection is
recommended.
CAUTION
• Most speakers with both High and Low terminals
have two metal plates that connect the High to the
Low terminals. These must be removed when you are
bi-amping the speakers or you could severely
damage the amplifier. See your speaker manual for
more information.
• If your speakers have a removable crossover network,
make sure you do not remove it for bi-amping. Doing
so may damage your speakers.
CAUTION
• Don’t connect different speakers from the same
terminal in this way.
• When bi-wiring as well, heed the cautions for bi-
amping shown at the left.
21
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
Selecting the Speaker system
03
ZONE 2 setup
With these connections you can simultaneously enjoy
5.1-channel surround sound in the main zone with stereo
playback on another component in ZONE 2.
The front height terminals can be used for front wide and
Speaker B connections, in addition to for the front height
speakers. Also, the surround back terminals can be used
for bi-amping and ZONE 2 connections, in addition to for
the surround back speakers. Make this setting according
to the application.
1
Connect a pair of speakers to the surround back
speaker terminals.
See Standard surround connection on page 20.
2
Select ‘ZONE 2’ from the Speaker System menu.
Front height setup
*Default setting
See Speaker system setting on page 85 to do this.
1
Connect a pair of speakers to the front height
About the audio connection
speaker terminals.
See Standard surround connection on page 20.
Types of cables and
terminals
Transferable audio
signals
2
If necessary, select ‘Normal(SB/FH)’ from the
Speaker System menu.
See Speaker system setting on page 85 to do this.
HDMI
HD audio
Front wide setup
1
Connect a pair of speakers to the front height
speaker terminals.
See Standard surround connection on page 20.
Digital (Coaxial)
Conventional digital audio
Conventional analog audio
2
Select ‘Normal(SB/FW)’ from the Speaker System
Digital (Optical)
menu.
See Speaker system setting on page 85 to do this.
Speaker B setup
You can listen to stereo playback in another room.
RCA (Analog)
(White/Red)
1
Connect a pair of speakers to the front height
speaker terminals.
See Standard surround connection on page 20.
2
Select ‘Speaker B’ from the Speaker System menu.
See Speaker system setting on page 85 to do this.
• With an HDMI cable, video and audio signals can be
transferred in high quality over a single cable.
Bi-Amping setup
Bi-amping connection of the front speakers for high
sound quality with 5.1-channel surround sound.
About the video converter
1
Connect bi-amp compatible speakers to the front
The video converter ensures that all video sources are
output through all of the MONITOR VIDEO OUT jacks.
The only exception is HDMI: since this resolution cannot
be downsampled, you must connect your monitor/TV to
the receiver’s HDMI video outputs when connecting this
and surround back speaker terminals.
See Bi-amping your speakers on page 21.
2
Select ‘Front Bi-Amp’ from the Speaker System
menu.
1
video source.
See Speaker system setting on page 85 to do this.
Note
1 • If the video signal does not appear on your TV, try adjusting the resolution settings on your component or display. Note that some
components (such as video game units) have resolutions that may not be converted. In this case, try switching Digital Video Conversion (in
Setting the Video options on page 62) OFF.
• The signal input resolutions that can be converted from the component video input for the HDMI output are 480i/576i, 480p/576p, 720p and
1080i. 1080p signals cannot be converted.
• Only signals with an input resolution of 480i/576i can be converted from the component video input for the composite MONITOR OUT
terminals.
22
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
If several video components are assigned to the same
input function (see The Input Setup menu on page 40),
the converter gives priority to HDMI, component, then
composite (in that order).
1
About HDMI
The HDMI connection transfers uncompressed digital
video, as well as almost every kind of digital audio.
Terminal for connection
Terminal for connection
with TV monitor
with source device
This receiver incorporates High-Definition Multimedia
®
Interface (HDMI ) technology.
This receiver supports the functions described below
through HDMI connections.
HDMI IN
HDMI OUT
2
• Digital transfer of uncompressed video (contents
protected by HDCP (1080p/24, 1080p/60, etc.))
Y
P
B
P
R
Y
PB
PR
3
• 3D signal transfer
COMPONENT
VIDEO IN
COMPONENT VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
3
• Deep Color signal transfer
3
• x.v.Color signal transfer
3
• Audio Return Channel
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
VIDEO IN
• Input of multi-channel linear PCM digital audio
Video signals can be output
signals (192 kHz or less) for up to 8 channels
4
• Input of the following digital audio formats:
• For optimal video performance, THX recommends
switching Digital Video Conversion (in Setting the
Video options on page 62) OFF.
– Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital Plus, DTS, High bitrate
audio (Dolby TrueHD, DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-
HD High Resolution Audio), DVD-Audio, CD, SACD
(DSD signal), Video CD, Super VCD
This product incorporates copyright protection technology that is
protected by U.S. patents and other intellectual property rights.
Use of this copyright protection technology must be authorized by
Rovi Corporation, and is intended for home and other limited
viewing uses only unless otherwise authorized by Rovi
• Synchronized operation with components using the
Control with HDMI function (see Control with HDMI
function on page 57)
Corporation. Reverse engineering or disassembly is prohibited.
HDMI, the HDMI logo and High-Definition Multimedia
Interface are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI
Licensing, LLC in the United States and other countries.
“x.v.Color” and x.v.Color logo are trademarks of Sony
Corporation.
Note
1 • An HDMI connection can only be made with DVI-equipped components compatible with both DVI and High Bandwidth Digital Content
Protection (HDCP). If you choose to connect to a DVI connector, you will need a separate adaptor (DVIHDMI) to do so. A DVI connection,
however, does not support audio signals. Consult your local audio dealer for more information.
• If you connect a component that is not compatible with HDCP, an HDCP ERROR message is displayed on the front panel display. Some
components that are compatible with HDCP still cause this message to be displayed, but so long as there is no problem with displaying video
this is not a malfunction.
• Depending on the component you have connected, using a DVI connection may result in unreliable signal transfers.
• This receiver supports SACD, Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby TrueHD and DTS-HD Master Audio. To take advantage of these formats, however,
make sure that the component connected to this receiver also supports the corresponding format.
®
®
2 • Use a High Speed HDMI cable. If an HDMI cable other than a High Speed HDMI cable is used, it may not work properly.
• When an HDMI cable with a built-in equalizer is connected, it may not operate properly.
3 Signal transfer is only possible when connected to a compatible component.
4 • HDMI format digital audio transmissions require a longer time to be recognized. Due to this, interruption in the audio may occur when
switching between audio formats or beginning playback.
• Turning on/off the device connected to this unit's HDMI OUT terminal during playback, or disconnecting/connecting the HDMI cable during
playback, may cause noise or interrupted audio.
23
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
Connecting your TV and playback components
Connecting using HDMI
If you have an HDMI or DVI (with HDCP) equipped component (Blu-ray disc player (BD), etc.), you can connect it to
this receiver using a commercially available HDMI cable.
If the TV and playback components support the Control with HDMI feature, the convenient Control with HDMI
functions can be used (see Control with HDMI function on page 57).
HDMI/DVI-compatible
Blu-ray disc player
Other HDMI/DVI-
equipped component
HDMI/DVI-compatible
monitor
Select one
DIGITAL OUT
HDMI OUT
HDMI OUT
HDMI IN
AUDIO OUT
R
L
ANALOG
COAXIAL OPTICAL
This connection is
required in order to
listen to the sound of
the TV over the
1
receiver.
OUT 1
OUT 2
(
)
XM
IN
ADAPTER PORT
LAN 10/100
BD
IN
IN
1
IN
2
IN
3
IN
4
(
)
CONTROL
HDMI
(OUTPUT
5
V
ASSIGNABLE
)
100 mA MAX
1
4
COMPONENTVIDEO
ASSIGNABLE
SIRIUS COAXIAL
TICAL
ASSIGNABLE
I
ASSIGNA
(
)
DVD
IN
IN
IN
1
2
3
IN
IN
1
IN
1
3
MONITOR
OUT
OUT
(
)
(
)
(
)
DVD
TV/SAT
VIDEO
(
)
DVR/BDR
VIDEO
CD-R/TAPE
IN
ZONE2
OUT
ZONE3
OUT
DVD
IN
TV/SAT
IN
VIDEO
IN
DVR/BDR
OUT IN
PHONO
IN
CD
IN
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK FH/FW
(Single)
FRONT CEN
(
)
OUT
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
ZONE 2 OUT
SUBWOOFER
PRE OUT
SUBW
SIGNAL
Y
PB
PR
GND
ANTENNA
FRONT HEIGHT/WIDE/
B
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
R
L
R
L
(Single)
R
L
SPEAKERS
Class 2Wiring
AM LOOP
FM UNBAL 75
SELECTABLE
SEE INSTRUCTION
MANUAL
CONTROL
IR
12V
RS-232C
IN
IN
1
TRIGGER
1
2
IN
SELECTABLE
VOIR LE MODE
D'EMPLOI
(OUTPUT
12V
TOTAL
(
OUTPUT
5
V
)
2
150 mA MAX
OUT
150 mA MAX)
CAUTION:
OUT
SPEAKER IMPEDANCE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
EXTENSION
ATTENTION:
ENCEINTE D'IMPEDANCE DE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
• When connecting to an HDMI/DVI-compatible
monitor using the HDMI OUT 2 terminal, switch the
HDMI output setting to HDMI OUT 2 or HDMI OUT
ALL. See Switching the HDMI output on page 65.
• For input components, connections other than HDMI
connections are also possible (see Connecting your
DVD player with no HDMI output on page 25).
• If you want to listen to the sound of the TV over the
receiver, connect the receiver and TV with audio
1
cables.
Note
1 When the TV and receiver are connected by HDMI connections, if the TV supports the HDMI Audio Return Channel function, the sound of the
TV is input to the receiver via the HDMI OUT 1 terminal, so there is no need to connect an audio cable. In this case, set TV Audio at HDMI
Setup to via HDMI (see HDMI Setup on page 57).
24
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
Connecting your DVD player with no HDMI output
This diagram shows connections of a TV (with HDMI input) and DVD player (or other playback component with no
HDMI output) to the receiver.
DVD player, etc.
HDMI/DVI-compatible
monitor
Select one
Select one
HDMI IN
VIDEO OUT
VIDEO
AUDIO OUT
DIGITAL OUT
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
PR
PB
R
L
ANALOG
COAXIAL OPTICAL
Y
OUT 1
OUT 2
(
)
XM
IN
ADAPTER PORT
(OUTPUT
100 mA MAX
LAN 10/100
BD
IN
IN
1
IN
2
IN
3
IN
4
(
)
CONTROL
HDMI
5
V
)
ASSIGNABLE
1
4
COMPONENTVIDEO
ASSIGNABLE
SIRIUS COAXIAL
ASSIGNA
PTICAL
ASSIGNABLE
IN
(
)
DVD
IN
IN
IN
1
IN
IN
1
IN
1
2
I
MONITOR
OUT
(
)
(
)
(
)
DVD
TV/SAT
DVR/BDR
OUT
)
R/BDR
VIDEO
CD-R/TAPE
IN
ZONE2
OUT
ZONE3
OUT
DVD
IN
VIDEO
IN
DVR/BDR
OUT IN
PHONO
IN
CD
IN
OUT
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK FH/FW
(Single)
FRONT CENTER
S
)
EO
MONITOR OUT
ZONE 2 OUT
SUBWOOFER
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
SIGNAL
Y
PB
PR
GND
ANTENNA
FRONT HEIGHT/WIDE/
B
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
R
L
R
L
(Single)
R
L
SPEAKERS
Class 2Wiring
AM LOOP
FM UNBAL 75
SELECTABLE
SEE INSTRUCTION
MANUAL
CONTROL
IR
12V
RS-232C
IN
IN
1
TRIGGER
1
2
IN
SELECTABLE
VOIR LE MODE
D'EMPLOI
(OUTPUT
12V
TOTAL
(
OUTPUT
5
V
)
2
150 mA MAX
OUT
150 mA MAX)
CAUTION:
OUT
SPEAKER IMPEDANCE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
EXTENSION
ATTENTION:
ENCEINTE D'IMPEDANCE DE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
• If you want to listen to the sound of the TV over the
receiver, connect the receiver and TV with audio
1
cables (page 24).
• If you use an optical digital audio cable, you’ll need to
tell the receiver which digital input you connected the
player to (see The Input Setup menu on page 40).
Note
1 When the TV and receiver are connected by HDMI connections, if the TV supports the HDMI Audio Return Channel function, the sound of the
TV is input to the receiver via the HDMI OUT 1 terminal, so there is no need to connect an audio cable. In this case, set TV Audio at HDMI
Setup to via HDMI (see HDMI Setup on page 57).
25
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
Connecting your TV with no HDMI input
This diagram shows connections of a TV (with no HDMI input) and DVD player (or other playback component) to the
receiver.
• With these connections, the picture is not output to the TV even if the DVD player is connected with an HDMI cable.
Connect the DVD player’s video signals using a composite or component cord.
DVD player, etc.
TV
Select one
Select one
Select one
VIDEO IN
VIDEO
VIDEO OUT
VIDEO
HDMI OUT
AUDIO OUT
ANALOG
DIGITAL OUT
COMPONENT VIDEO IN
PR
PB
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
PR
PB
R
L
Y
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
Y
OUT 1
OUT 2
(
)
XM
IN
ADAPTER PORT
LAN 10/100
BD
IN
IN
1
IN
2
IN
3
IN
(
)
CONTROL
HDMI
ASSIGNABLE
(OUTPUT
4
5
V
)
100 mA MAX
1
4
COMPONENTVIDEO
ASSIGNABLE
SIRIUS COAXIAL
PTICAL
ASSIGNABLE
IN
ASSIGN
(
)
DVD
IN
IN
IN
1
2
3
IN
IN
1
IN
1
2
MONITOR
OUT
OUT
(
)
(
)
(
)
DVD
TV/SAT
DVR/BDR
(
DVR/B
VIDEO
CD-R/TAPE
IN
ZONE3
OUT
DVD
IN
TV/SAT
IN
VIDEO
IN
DVR/BDR
OUT IN
PHONO
IN
CD
IN
OUT
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK FH/FW
(Single)
FRONT CENTER
S
(
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
ZOUT
SUBWOOFER
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
SIGNAL
GND
NTEN
FRONT HEIGHT/WIDE/
B
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
R
L
R
L
(Single)
R
L
SPEAKERS
Class 2Wiring
AM LOOP
FM UNBAL 75
SELECTABLE
SEE INSTRUCTION
MANUAL
CONTROL
IR
12V
RS-232C
IN
IN
1
TRIGGER
1
2
IN
SELECTABLE
VOIR LE MODE
D'EMPLOI
(OUTPUT
12V
TOTAL
(
OUTPUT
5
V
)
2
150 mA MAX
OUT
150 mA MAX)
CAUTION:
OUT
SPEAKER IMPEDANCE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
EXTENSION
ATTENTION:
ENCEINTE D'IMPEDANCE DE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
• Connect using an HDMI cable to listen to HD audio
on the receiver. Do not use an HDMI cable to input
video signals.
Depending on the video component, it may not be
possible to output signals connected by HDMI and
other methods simultaneously, and it may be
necessary to make output settings. Please refer to the
operating instructions supplied with your component
for more information.
• If you want to listen to the sound of the TV over the
receiver, connect the receiver and TV with audio
cables (page 24).
• If you use an optical digital audio cable, you’ll need to
tell the receiver which digital input you connected the
player to (see The Input Setup menu on page 40).
26
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
Connecting an HDD/DVD recorder, BD recorder and other video sources
This receiver has two sets of audio/video inputs and outputs suitable for connecting analog or digital video devices,
including HDD/DVD recorders and BD recorders.
When you set up the receiver you’ll need to tell the receiver which input you connected the recorder to (see also The
Input Setup menu on page 40).
HDD/DVD recorder, BD recorder, etc.
Select one
DIGITAL OUT
VIDEO IN
VIDEO
VIDEO OUT
VIDEO
AUDIO IN
ANALOG
AUDIO OUT
R
L
R
L
ANALOG
COAXIAL OPTICAL
OUT 1
OUT 2
(
)
XM
IN
ADAPTER PORT
(OUTPUT
100 mA MAX
LAN 10/100
BD
IN
IN
1
IN
IN
3
IN
4
(
)
CONTROL
HDMI
2
5
V
)
ASSIGNABLE
1
4
COMPONENTVIDEO
ASSIGNABLE
SIRIUS COAXIAL
TICAL
ASSIGNABLE
IN
ASSIGNA
(
)
DVD
IN
IN
IN
1
2
3
IN
IN
1
IN
1
2
MONITOR
OUT
(
)
(
)
(
)
DVD
TV/SAT
DVR/BDR
OUT
(
)
DVR/BDR
CD-R/TAPE
IN
ZONE2
OUT
ZONE3
OUT
DVD
IN
TV/SAT
IN
VIDEO
IN
DVR/BDR
OUT IN
PHONO
IN
CD
IN
OUT
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK FH/FW
(Single)
FRONT CENTER
S
(
)
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
ZONE 2 OUT
SUBWOOFER
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
SIGNAL
Y
PB
PR
GND
ANTENNA
FRONT HEIGHT/WIDE/
B
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
R
L
R
L
(Single)
R
L
SPEAKERS
Class 2Wiring
AM LOOP
FM UNBAL 75
SELECTABLE
SEE INSTRUCTION
MANUAL
CONTROL
IR
12V
RS-232C
IN
IN
1
TRIGGER
1
2
IN
SELECTABLE
VOIR LE MODE
D'EMPLOI
(OUTPUT
12V
TOTAL
(
OUTPUT
5
V
)
2
150 mA MAX
OUT
150 mA MAX)
CAUTION:
OUT
SPEAKER IMPEDANCE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
EXTENSION
ATTENTION:
ENCEINTE D'IMPEDANCE DE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
• In order to record, you must connect the analog
audio cables (the digital connection is for playback
only) (page 64).
• If your HDD/DVD recorder, BD recorder, etc., is
equipped with an HDMI output terminal, we
recommend connecting it to the receiver’s HDMI IN
terminal. When doing so, also connect the receiver
and TV by HDMI (see Connecting using HDMI on
page 24).
27
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
Connecting a satellite/cable receiver or other set-top box
Satellite and cable receivers, and terrestrial digital TV tuners are all examples of so-called ‘set-top boxes’.
When you set up the receiver you’ll need to tell the receiver which input you connected the set-top box to (see The Input
Setup menu on page 40).
STB
Select one
VIDEO OUT
VIDEO
AUDIO OUT
DIGITAL OUT
R
L
ANALOG
COAXIAL OPTICAL
OUT 1
OUT 2
)
(
)
XM
IN
ADAPTER PORT
(OUTPUT
100 mA MAX
LAN 10/100
BD
IN
IN
1
IN
2
IN
3
IN
4
(
CONTROL
HDMI
5
V
)
ASSIGNABLE
1
4
COMPONENTVIDEO
ASSIGNABLE
SIRIUS COAXIAL
ASSIGNA
TICAL
ASSIGNABLE
IN
(
)
DVD
IN
IN
IN
1
2
3
IN
IN
1
IN
1
MONITOR
OUT
(
)
(
)
(
)
DVD
TV/SAT
D
IDEO
OUT
(
)
DVR/BDR
VIDEO
CD-R/TAPE
IN
ZONE2
OUT
ZONE3
OUT
DVD
IN
TV/SAT
IN
VIDEO
IN
DVR/BDR
OUT IN
PHONO
IN
CD
IN
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK FH/FW
(Single)
FRONT CENTER SU
(
)
OUT
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
ZONE 2 OUT
SUBWOOFER
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
SIGNAL
Y
PB
PR
GND
ANTENNA
FRONT HEIGHT/WIDE/
B
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
R
L
R
L
(Single)
R
L
SPEAKERS
Class 2Wiring
AM LOOP
FM UNBAL 75
SELECTABLE
SEE INSTRUCTION
MANUAL
CONTROL
IR
12V
RS-232C
IN
IN
1
TRIGGER
1
2
IN
SELECTABLE
VOIR LE MODE
D'EMPLOI
(OUTPUT
12V
TOTAL
(
OUTPUT
5
V
)
2
150 mA MAX
OUT
150 mA MAX)
CAUTION:
OUT
SPEAKER IMPEDANCE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
EXTENSION
ATTENTION:
ENCEINTE D'IMPEDANCE DE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
• If your set-top box is equipped with an HDMI output
terminal, we recommend connecting it to the
receiver’s HDMI IN terminal. When doing so, also
connect the receiver and TV by HDMI (see
Connecting using HDMI on page 24).
28
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
Connecting the multichannel analog inputs
For DVD Audio and SACD playback, your DVD player may have 5.1, 6.1 or 7.1 channel analog outputs (depending on
whether your player supports surround back channels). Make sure that the player is set to output multichannel analog
audio.
DVD player, etc.
VIDEO OUT
VIDEO
SUBWOOFER
OUTPUT
FRONT
OUTPUT
CENTER
OUTPUT
SURROUND
OUTPUT
R
SURROUND BACK
OUTPUT
R
L
L
R
L
OUT 1
OUT 2
(
)
XM
IN
ADAPTER PORT
LAN 10/100
IN
1
IN
2
IN
3
IN
4
(
)
CONTROL
(
OUTPUT 5 V
)
100 mA MAX
SIRIUS COAXIAL
OPTICAL
ASSIGNABLE
ASSIGNABLE
IN
IN
IN
1
IN
2
IN
1
2
IN
3
MONITOR
OUT
OUT
(
)
(
)
(
)
(
)
(
)
DVD
CD
TV/SAT
DVR/BDR
VIDEO
VIDEO
CD-R/TAPE
IN
ZONE2
OUT
ZONE3
OUT
DVD
IN
TV/SAT
IN
VIDEO
IN
DVR/BDR
OUT IN
PHONO
IN
CD
IN
OUT
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK FH/FW
(Single)
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK
L
R
SUBWOOFER
PRE OUT
MULTI CH IN
SUBWOOFER
SIGNAL
GND
FRONT HEIGHT/WIDE/
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
FRONT
CENTER
B
R
L
R
L
(Single)
R
L
R
L
SPEAKERS
Class 2Wiring
FM UNBAL 75
SELECTABLE
SEE INSTRUCTION
MANUAL
IR
12V
IN
IN
1
TRIGGER
1
2
SELECTABLE
VOIR LE MODE
D'EMPLOI
(OUTPUT
12V
TOTAL
2
150 mA MAX)
CAUTION:
OUT
SPEAKER IMPEDANCE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
ATTENTION:
ENCEINTE D'IMPEDANCE DE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
• If there is a single surround back output, connect it to
the SURROUND BACK L jack on this receiver.
• To use a 5.1-channel speaker set, use the surround
speakers for the surround channel, not the surround
back channel.
• The audio signal input to MULTI CH IN cannot be
downmixed.
29
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
Connecting other audio components
This receiver has both digital and analog inputs, allowing you to connect audio components for playback.
When you set up the receiver you’ll need to tell the receiver which input you connected the component to (see also The
Input Setup menu on page 40).
Turntable
CD-R, MD, DAT, etc.
Select one
Select one
DIGITAL IN
AUDIO OUT
AUDIO IN
DIGITAL OUT
R
L
ANALOG
R
L
ANALOG
COAXIAL OPTICAL
OPTICAL
OUT 1
OUT 2
(
)
XM
ADAPTER PORT
LAN 10/100
IN
3
IN
4
(
)
CONTROL
(
OUTPUT
5
V
)
100 mA MAX
SIS COAXIAL
OPTICAL
ASSIGNABL
IN
ASSIGNABLE
IN
IN
2
IN
1
IN
3
MONITOR
OUT
(
)
(
)
(
)
(
)
CD
TV/SAT
DVR/BDR
VIDEO
OUT
VIDEO
CD-R/TAPE
IN
TV/SAT
IN
VIDEO
IN
DVR/BDR
OUT IN
PHONO
IN
CD
IN
OUT
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK FH/F
(Single)
RONT CENTER SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
SIGNAL
GND
FRONT HEIGHT/WIDE/
B
SUND BACK
SURROUND
R
L
L
(Single)
R
L
R
SPEAKERS
Class 2Wiring
SELECTABLE
SEE INSTRUCTION
MANUAL
12V
TRIGGER
1
2
SELECTABLE
VOIR LE MODE
D'EMPLOI
(OUTPUT
12V
TOTAL
150 mA MAX)
CAUTION:
SPEAKER IMPEDANCE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
ATTENTION:
ENCEINTE D'IMPEDANCE DE 6 Ω - 16 Ω .
• If you’re connecting a recorder, connect the analog
audio outputs to the analog audio inputs on the
recorder.
About the WMA9 Pro decoder
This unit has an on-board Windows Media™ Audio 9
1
Professional (WMA9 Pro) decoder, so it is possible to
playback WMA9 Pro-encoded audio using HDMI, coaxial
or optical digital connection when connected to a WMA9
Pro-compatible player. However, the connected DVD
player, set-top box, etc. must be able to output WMA9 Pro
format audio signals through a coaxial or optical digital
output.
• You can’t hear HDMI audio through this receiver’s
digital out jack.
Turntables only:
• If your turntable has a grounding wire, secure it to the
ground terminal on this receiver.
• If your turntable has line-level outputs (i.e., it has a
built-in phono pre-amp), connect it to the CD inputs
instead.
Note
1 • Windows Media and the Windows logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other
countries.
• With WMA9 Pro, sound problems may occur depending on your computer system. Note that WMA9 Pro 96 kHz sources will be
downsampled to 48 kHz.
30
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
Connecting additional amplifiers
Connecting AM/FM antennas
This receiver has more than enough power for any home
use, but it’s possible to add additional amplifiers to every
channel of your system using the pre-outs. Make the
connections shown below to add amplifiers to power
your speakers.
Connect the AM loop antenna and the FM wire antenna
as shown below. To improve reception and sound quality,
connect external antennas (see Connecting external
antennas on page 32).
ANALOG
INPUT
1
2
L
Front channel
amplifier
R
ANALOG
INPUT
3
ANTENNA
AM LOOP
Center channel
amplifier (mono)
5
ANALOG
INPUT
FM UNBAL 75
4
L
Surround
channel amplifier
R
)
XM
IN
ADAPTER PORT
/100
(
OUTPUT
5
V
)
fig. a
fig. b
fig. c
100 mA MAX
ANALOG
INPUT
ASE
SIGNABLE
AL
TIC
IN
N
1
2
IN
3
OUT
(
)
(
)
CD
D-
SAT
BDR
VIDEO
L
Front height or
Front wide
channel amplifier
R
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK FH/FW
(Single)
FRONT CENT
ANALOG
INPUT
SUBWOOFER
PRE OUT
SUBWO
L
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
1
Pull off the protective shields of both AM antenna
L
(Single)
R
R
wires.
Surround back
channel amplifier
ANALOG
INPUT
2
Push open the tabs, then insert one wire fully into
each terminal, then release the tabs to secure the AM
antenna wires.
TION:
R
IMPEDANCE
6
Ω - 16 Ω .
NTION:
E
D'IMPEDANCE DE Ω - 16 Ω .
6
Powered
3
Fix the AM loop antenna to the attached stand.
subwoofer
To fix the stand to the antenna, bend in the direction
indicated by the arrow (fig. a) then clip the loop onto the
stand (fig. b).
• You can use the additional amplifier on the surround
back channel pre-outs for a single speaker as well. In
this case plug the amplifier into the left (L (Single))
terminal only.
• If you plan to mount the AM antenna to a wall or other
surface, secure the stand with screws (fig. c) before
clipping the loop to the stand. Make sure the
reception is clear.
• The sound from the surround back terminals will
depend on how you have configured the Speaker
system setting on page 85.
4
Place the AM antenna on a flat surface and in a
• To hear sound only from the pre-outs, switch the
speaker system to OFF, or simply disconnect any
speakers that are connected directly to the receiver.
direction giving the best reception.
5
Connect the FM wire antenna into the FM antenna
socket.
If you’re not using a subwoofer, change the front speaker
setting (see Speaker Setting on page 85) to LARGE.
For best results, extend the FM antenna fully and fix to a
wall or door frame. Don’t drape loosely or leave coiled up.
31
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
Connecting external antennas
To improve FM reception, connect an external FM
antenna to FM UNBAL 75 Ω.
Making MULTI-ZONE connections
It is possible to make these connections if you have a
separate TV and speakers for your primary (ZONE 2) sub
zone, and a separate TV and a separate amplifier (and
speakers) for your secondary (ZONE 3) sub zone. You will
also need a separate amplifier if you are not using the
MULTI-ZONE setup using speaker terminals (ZONE 2) on
page 33 for your primary sub zone. There are two primary
sub zone setups possible with this system. Choose
whichever works best for you.
75 Ω coaxial cable
ANTENNA
MULTI-ZONE listening options
The following table shows the signals that can be output
1
AM LOOP
FM UNBAL 75
to ZONE 2 and ZONE 3 :
Sub Zone
ZONE 2
Input functions available
To improve AM reception, connect a 5 m to 6 m (16 ft. to 20
ft.) length of vinyl-coated wire to the AM LOOP terminals
without disconnecting the supplied AM loop antenna.
DVD, TV/SAT, DVR/BDR, VIDEO, INTERNET
RADIO, iPod/USB, XM RADIO, CD, CD-R/TAPE,
TUNER, ADAPTER PORT, SIRIUS
For the best possible reception, suspend horizontally
outdoors.
(Outputs analog audio, composite video and
component video.)
Outdoor antenna
ZONE 3
Same as ZONE 2 above.
(Outputs analog audio and composite video.)
Basic MULTI-ZONE setup (ZONE 2)
Connect a separate amplifier to the AUDIO ZONE 2
Indoor antenna
(vinyl-coated wire)
•
ANTENNA
OUT jacks and a TV monitor to the VIDEO ZONE 2 OUT2
jack, both on this receiver.
You should have a pair of speakers attached to the sub
zone amplifier as shown in the following illustration.
5 m to 6 m
(16 ft. to 20 ft.)
AM LOOP
FM UNBAL 75
Sub zone (ZONE 2)
Main zone
MULTI-ZONE setup
BD
IN
IN
1
IN
2
This receiver can power up to three independent systems
in separate rooms after you have made the proper MULTI-
ZONE connections.
HDMI
ASSIGNABLE
1
4
COMPONENTVIDE
ASSIGNABLE
VIDEO IN
IN
IN
IN
1
2
3
(
)
DVR/BDR
Different sources can be playing in three zones at the
same time or, depending on your needs, the same source
can also be used. The main and sub zones have
independent power (the main zone power can be off while
one (or both) of the sub zones is on) and the sub zones
can be controlled by the remote or front panel controls.
ZONE2
OUT
ZONE3
OUT
D
(
)
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
ZONE OUT
2
Y
PB
PR
ANTENNA
AUDIO IN
R
L
AM LOOP
FM UNBAL 75
CONTROL
IR
RS-232C
IN
IN
1
IN
(
OUTPUT
5
V
)
2
150 mA MAX
OUT
OUT
EXTENSION
Note
1 For the INTERNET RADIO, XM RADIO, SIRIUS and iPod/USB inputs, it is not possible use the same input in ZONE 2 and ZONE 3
simultaneously.
2 • COMPONENT VIDEO ZONE 2 OUT can be used to output clear images.
• The GUI screen is not displayed if only the COMPONENT VIDEO ZONE 2 OUT jack is connected.
• The video convert function does not work for ZONE 2. Connect the composite video and component video to the same types of jacks for the
inputs and outputs.
32
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
MULTI-ZONE setup using speaker terminals (ZONE 2)
You must select ZONE 2 in Speaker system setting on
page 85 to use this setup.
Connecting to the network through
LAN interface
•
Connect a TV monitor to the VIDEO ZONE 2 OUT
By connecting this receiver to the network via the LAN
jacks on this receiver.1
2
terminal, you can listen to Internet radio stations.
You should have a pair of speakers attached to the
surround back speaker terminals as shown below.
OUT 1
OUT 2
(
)
XM
IN
LAN 10/100
(
)
CONTROL
Main zone
Sub zone (ZONE 2)
SIRIUS COAXIAL
OPTICAL
SSIGNABLE
IN
ASSIGNABLE
IN
IN
1
IN
2
2
MONITOR
(
)
(
)
(
(
)
DVD
CD
DVR/BDR
OUT
OUT 2
IN
(
)
XM
IN
ADAPTER P
(OUTPUT
100 mA MAX
LAN 10/100
BD
IN
IN
1
Internet
2
5
V
)
VIDEO
CD-R/TAPE
IN
ENTVIDEO
NABLE
DVR/BDR
OUT IN
PHONO
IN
CD
IN
SIRIUS COAXIAL
OPTICAL
ASSIGNABLE
IN IN
ASSIGNABLE
OUT
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
(
)
DVD
IN
IN
1
3
IN
IN
1
IN
2
1
2
IN
3
OUT
(
)
(
)
(
)
(
)
(
)
DVD
CD
TV/SAT
DVR/BDR
VIDEO
Modem
DEO
VIDEO IN
CD-R/TAPE
IN
ZONE2
OUT
ZONE3CD DVD
OUT IN
IN
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK FH/FW
(Single)
(
)
OUT
VIDEO
SUBWOOFER
MONITOR OUT
SIGNAL
GND
ZONE
2
OUT
SUBWOOFER
PRE OU
FRONT HEIGHT/WIDE/
B
SURROUND BACK
R
L
R
L
(Single
L
PB
PR
KERS
Wiring
ANTENNA
HT/WIDE/
B
SURROUND BACK
SU
L
R
L
(Single)
R
TABLE
TRUCTION
L
L
R
AM LOOP
FM UNBAL 75
TABLE
MODE
OI
LAN
CONTROL
IR
1
T
IN
IN
1
3
2
1
WAN
1
2
IN
(
2
1
T
1
OUT
Router
CAUTION:
OUT
SPEAKER IMPEDANCE
ATTENTION:
6
Ω - 16 Ω .
Ω - 16 Ω .
ENCEINTE D'IMPEDANCE DE
6
LAN cable
(sold separately)
to LAN port
PC
Secondary MULTI-ZONE setup (ZONE 3)
Connect a separate amplifier to the AUDIO ZONE 3
OUT jacks and a TV monitor to the VIDEO ZONE 3 OUT
jack, both on this receiver.
You should have a pair of speakers attached to the sub
zone amplifier as shown in the following illustration.
Connect the LAN terminal on this receiver to the LAN
terminal on your router (with or without the built-in DHCP
server function) with a straight LAN cable (CAT 5 or
higher).
•
Turn on the DHCP server function of your router. In case
your router does not have the built-in DHCP server
function, it is necessary to set up the network manually.
For details, see Network Setup menu on page 87.
Main zone
Sub zone (ZONE 3)
BD
IN
IN
1
IN
2
IN
3
HDMI
ASSIGNABLE
1
4
COMPONENTVIDEO
ASSIGNABLE
VIDEO IN
(
)
DVD
IN
IN
IN
1
2
3
LAN terminal specifications
(
D
LAN terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .Ethernet jack
10BASE-T/100BASE-TX
ZONE2
OUT
ZONE3
OUT
DVD
IN
TV/
I
(
)
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
ZONE 2 OUT
Y
PB
PR
ANTENNA
AUDIO IN
R
L
AM LOOP
FM UNBAL 75
CONTROL
IR
12V
RS-232C
IN
IN
1
TRIG
1
2
IN
(OUT
12V
TOTA
(
OUTPUT
5
V
)
2
150 mA MAX
OUT
150
m
OUT
EXTENSION
Note
1 • COMPONENT VIDEO ZONE 2 OUT can be used to output clear images.
• The GUI screen is not displayed if only the COMPONENT VIDEO ZONE 2 OUT jack is connected.
• The video convert function does not work for ZONE 2. Connect the composite video and component video to the same types of jacks for the
inputs and outputs.
2 To listen to Internet radio stations, you must sign a contract with an ISP (Internet Service Provider) beforehand.
33
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
Connecting Optional Bluetooth®
Connecting an XM Radio tuner
After purchasing an XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock
(both sold separately), you will also need to activate the
XM Radio service to begin receiving broadcasts.
ADAPTER
When the Bluetooth ADAPTER (Pioneer Model No. AS-
1
BT100) is connected to this receiver, a product equipped
with Bluetooth wireless technology (portable cell phone,
AC IN
(
)
XM
IN
ADAPTER PORT
LAN 10/100
digital music player, etc.) can be used to listen to music
(
OUTPUT
5
V
)
100 mA MAX
2
wirelessly.
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
ASSIGNABLE
IN
ASSIGNABLE
IN
IN
1
2
IN
1
2
IN
3
OUT
(
)
(
)
(
)
(
)
(
)
DVD
CD
TV/SAT
DVR/BDR
VIDEO
Bluetooth® ADAPTER (sold separately)
-R/TAPE
IN
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK FH/FW
(Single)
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK
L
OUT 2
AC
(
)
XM
IN
ADAPTER PORT
LAN 10/100
(
OUTPUT
5
V
R
)
100 mA MAX
SUBWOOFER
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
MULTI CH IN
SIRIUS COAXIAL
OPTICAL
ASSIGNABLE
IN
ASSIGNABLE
IN
IN
1
IN
2
IN
1
2
IN
3
OUT
(
)
(
)
(
)
(
)
(
)
DVD
CD
TV/SAT
DVR/BDR
VIDEO
VIDEO
CD-R/TAPE
IN
CD
IN
OUT
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK
L
R
SUBWOOFER
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
MULTI CH IN
SATELLiTE
RADiO
GNAL
GND
SATELLiTE RADiO
•
Switch the receiver into standby and connect
XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock
Bluetooth ADAPTER to the ADAPTER PORT
.
with antenna
• For instructions on playing the Bluetooth wireless
technology device, see Pairing the Bluetooth
ADAPTER and Bluetooth wireless technology device
on page 51.
• For instructions on playing the XM Radio, see
Listening to XM Radio on page 47.
Connecting a SiriusConnect™ tuner
Important
To receive SIRIUS Satellite Radio broadcasts, you will
• Do not move the receiver with the Bluetooth
ADAPTER connected. Doing so could cause damage
or faulty contact.
need to activate your SiriusConnect™ tuner.
OUT 1
OUT 2
(
)
XM
IN
ADAPTER PORT
LAN 10/100
(
)
CONTROL
(
OUTPUT
5
V
)
100 mA MAX
SIRIUS COAXIAL
OPTICAL
ASSIGNABLE
IN
ASSIGNABLE
IN
IN
1
IN
2
IN
1
2
IN
3
MONITOR
Connecting an HDMI-equipped
OUT
(
)
(
)
(
)
(
)
(
)
DVD
CD
TV/SAT
DVR/BDR
VIDEO
OUT
VIDEO
component to the front panel input
CD-PE
DVR/BDR
IN
PHONO
IN
CD
IN
T
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK FH/FW
(Single)
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURR BACK
L
OUT
R
CONTROL ON/OFF
SUBWOOFER
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
MULTI CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
TUNER EDIT
BAND AUTO SURR/ALC/ HOME STANDARD ADVANCED STEREO
MULTI-ZONE
SPEAKERS
STREAM DIRECT THX
SURROUND SURROUND
Antenna
iPod
iPhone
HDMI 5
VIDEO CAMERA
USB
MCACC
SETUP MIC
SiriusConnect™
HOME tuner
PHONES
SIRIUS
H
AC adapter
You will also need to connect the antenna and AC
adapter to the SiriusConnect™ tuner.
For instructions on playing the SIRIUS Radio, see
Video camera, etc.
Listening to SIRIUS Radio on page 48.
Note
1 The Bluetooth ADAPTER (AS-BT100) is sold separately.
2 • The Bluetooth wireless technology enabled device must support A2DP profiles.
• Pioneer does not guarantee proper connection and operation of this unit with all Bluetooth wireless technology enabled devices.
34
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
Connecting an iPod
03
•
Switch the receiver into standby then connect your
USB device to the USB terminal on the front panel of
this receiver.1
This receiver has a dedicated iPod terminal that will allow
you to control playback of audio content from your iPod
using the controls of this receiver.
• For instructions on playing the USB device, see
Playing a USB device on page 44.
•
Switch the receiver into standby then use the
CONTROL ON/OFF
supplied iPod cable to connect your iPod to the iPod/
iPhone/USB terminal on the front panel of this receiver.
• It is also possible to connect using the cable included
with the iPod, but in this case it is not possible to view
pictures via the receiver.
TUNER EDIT
BAND AUTO SURR/ALC/ HOME STANDARD ADVANCED STEREO
MULTI-ZONE
SPEAKERS
STREAM DIRECT THX
SURROUND SURROUND
iPod
iPhone
HDMI
5
USB
MCACC
SETUP MIC
VIDEO CAMERA
PHONES
• For the cable connection, also refer to the operating
instructions for your iPod.
• For instructions on playing the iPod, see Playing an
iPod on page 43.
CONTROL ON/OFF
USB mass
storage device
TUNER EDIT
BAND AUTO SURR/ALC/ HOME STANDARD ADVANCED STEREO
MULTI-ZONE
SPEAKERS
STREAM DIRECT THX
SURROUND SURROUND
iPod
iPhone
USB keyboard
USB
HDMI
5
MCACC
SETUP MIC
VIDEO CAMERA
PHONES
Connecting a USB device for Advanced
MCACC output
iPod cable
(supplied)
When using Full Auto MCACC (page 38), Auto MCACC
(page 75) or Acoustic Calibration EQ Professional
(page 79) to calibrate the reverb characteristics of your
listening room, the 3D graphs of the reverb
MENU
characteristics in your listening room (before and after
calibration) can be checked on a computer screen.
iPod
The various MCACC parameters can also be checked on
the computer. MCACC data and parameters are
transferred from this receiver to a USB device and by
connecting the USB device to a computer, the data is
imported via the MCACC software in the computer.
Connecting a USB device
It is possible to play audio and photo files by connecting
USB devices to this receiver. It is also possible to connect
a USB keyboard (US-international layout) to the receiver
to enter text in the following GUI screens.
The MCACC software to output the results is available
from the support area of the Pioneer website (http://
www.pioneerelectronics.com/PUSA/
Home+Entertainment+Custom+Install). Instructions
for using the software are also available here. If you have
any questions regarding, please contact the Customer
Support Division of Pioneer.
• Change the input name in the Input Setup menu
(page 40).
• Add names to radio station presets (page 46).
• Enter Internet radio station URLs (page 49)
.
See the documentation provided with the Advanced MCACC
PC Display Application Software for more information.
• For the USB device connection and operations, see
2
Output MCACC data on page 82 .
Note
1 This receiver does not support a USB hub.
2 The various parameters and the reverb characteristics data used for display on the computer are not cleared when the power is turned off (see
Output MCACC data on page 82).
35
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
Connecting an IR receiver
03
Operating other Pioneer components
with this unit’s sensor
If you keep your stereo components in a closed cabinet or
shelving unit, or you wish to use the sub zone remote
control in another zone, you can use an optional IR
receiver (such as a Niles or Xantech unit) to control your
system instead of the remote sensor on the front panel of
Many Pioneer components have SR CONTROL jacks
which can be used to link components together so that
you can use just the remote sensor of one component.
When you use a remote control, the control signal is
1
this receiver.
2
passed along the chain to the appropriate component.
1
Connect the IR receiver sensor to the IR IN jack on
the rear of this receiver.
Important
Closet or shelving unit
• Note that if you use this feature, make sure that you
also have at least one set of analog audio, video or
HDMI jacks connected to another component for
grounding purposes.
Non-Pioneer
component
Pioneer
component
1
Decide which component you want to use the
CONTROL
IR
IN
remote sensor of.
IN
OUT
When you want to control any component in the chain,
this is the remote sensor at which you’ll point the
corresponding remote control.
BD
IN
IN
1
IN
2
IN
3
IN
4
HDMI
ASSIGNABLE
1
4
COMPONENTVIDEO
ASSIGNABLE
2
Connect the CONTROL OUT jack of that component
(
)
DVD
IN
IN
IN
1
2
3
to the CONTROL IN jack of another Pioneer component.
Use a cable with a mono mini-plug on each end for the
(
)
DVR/BDR
ZONE2
OUT
ZONE3
OUT
DVD
IN
TV/SAT
IN
VIDEO
IN
DVR/
OUT
(
)
VIDEO
connection.
MONITOR OUT
MONITOR OUT
ZONE 2 OUT
ZONE 2 OUT
Y
PB
PR
ANTENNA
Y
PB
PR
SPEAKERS
Class 2Wiring
ANTENNA
AM LOOP
FM UNBAL 75
SPEAKERS
Class 2Wiring
SELECTABLE
SEE INSTRUCTIO
MANUAL
CONTROL
IR
12V
RS-232C
IN
IN
1
TRIGGER
AM LOOP
FM UNBAL 75
1
2
IN
SELECTABLE
VOIR LE MODE
D'EMPLOI
SELECTABLE
SEE INSTRUCTIO
MANUAL
CONTROL
IR
12V
(OUTPUT
12V
TOTAL
RS-232C
IN
IN
1
(
OUTPUT
5
V
TRIGGER
2
1
2
)
IN
150 mA MAX
OUT
SELECTABLE
VOIR LE MODE
D'EMPLOI
150 mA MAX)
(OUTPUT
12V
TOTAL
(
OUTPUT
5
V
OUT
2
150 mA MA
OUT
EXTENSION
150 mA MAX)
OUT
EXTENSION
IR receiver
IN
OUT
IN
OUT
CONTROL
CONTROL
2
Connect the IR IN jack of another component to the
IR OUT jack on the rear of this receiver to link it to the
IR receiver.
Please see the manual supplied with your IR receiver for
the type of cable necessary for the connection.
Continue the chain in the same way for as many
components as you have.
• If you want to link a Pioneer component to the IR
receiver, see Operating other Pioneer components
with this unit’s sensor below to connect to the
CONTROL jacks instead of the IR OUT jack.
Note
1 • Remote operation may not be possible if direct light from a strong fluorescent lamp is shining on the IR receiver remote sensor window.
• Note that other manufacturers may not use the IR terminology. Refer to the manual that came with your component to check for IR
compatibility.
• If using two remote controls (at the same time), the IR receiver’s remote sensor takes priority over the remote sensor on the front panel.
2 • If you want to control all your components using this receiver’s remote control, see Setting the remote to control other components on
page 68.
• If you have connected a remote control to the CONTROL IN jack (using a mini-plug cable), you won’t be able to control this unit using the
remote sensor.
36
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your equipment
03
Switching components on and off using
the 12 volt trigger
Plugging in the receiver
Only plug in after you have connected all your
components to this receiver, including the speakers.
You can connect components in your system (such as a
screen or projector) to this receiver so that they switch on
or off using 12 volt triggers when you select an input
function. However, you must specify which input
functions switch on the trigger using the The Input Setup
menu on page 40. Note that this will only work with
components that have a standby mode.
1
Plug the supplied power cord into the AC IN socket
on the back of the receiver.
2
Plug the other end into a power outlet.1
CAUTION
• Handle the power cord by the plug part. Do not pull
out the plug by tugging the cord, and never touch the
power cord when your hands are wet, as this could
cause a short circuit or electric shock. Do not place
the unit, a piece of furniture, or other object on the
power cord or pinch the cord in any other way. Never
make a knot in the cord or tie it with other cables. The
power cords should be routed so that they are not
likely to be stepped on. A damaged power cord can
cause a fire or give you an electric shock. Check the
power cord once in a while. If you find it damaged,
ask your nearest Pioneer authorized independent
service company for a replacement.
OUT 1
OUT
BD
IN
IN
1
IN
2
IN
3
IN
4
(
)
CONTROL
HDMI
ASSIGNABLE
1
4
COMPONENTVIDEO
ASSIGNABLE
(
)
DVD
IN
IN
IN
1
2
3
MONITOR
OUT
(
)
DVR/BDR
VIDE
ZONE2
OUT
ZONE3
OUT
DVD
IN
TV/SAT
IN
VIDEO
IN
DVR/BDR
OUT IN
PHONO
IN
CD
IN
(
)
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
ZONE OUT
2
SIGNAL
Y
PB
PR
GND
ANTENNA
FRONT HEIGHT/W
R
SPEAKERS
Class 2Wiring
AM LOOP
FM UNBAL 75
SELECTABLE
SEE INSTRUCTION
MANUAL
CONTROL
IR
12V
TRIGGER
RS-232C
IN
IN
1
1
2
IN
SELECTABLE
VOIR LE MODE
D'EMPLOI
TPUT
TO
(
OUTPUT
150 mA MAX
5
V
)
2
OUT
150 mA MAX)
OUT
EXTENSION
• Do not use any power cord other than the one
supplied with this unit.
12 V TRIGGER
INPUT
• Do not use the supplied power cord for any purpose
other than that described below.
• The receiver should be disconnected by removing the
mains plug from the wall socket when not in regular
use, e.g., when on vacation.
•
Connect the 12 V TRIGGER jack of this receiver to
the 12 V trigger of another component.
Use a cable with a mono mini-plug on each end for the
connection.
• Make sure the blue STANDBY/ON light has gone
out before unplugging.
After you’ve specified the input functions that will switch
on the trigger, you’ll be able to switch the component on
or off just by pressing the input function(s) you’ve set on
page 40.
• If you have connected speakers with a 6 Ω
impedance, change the impedance setting before
turning on the power.
It is also possible to have the component switch not when
the input function is switched, but when HDMI OUT is
switched. For details, see HDMI Setup on page 57.
Note
1 After this receiver is connected to an AC outlet, a 2 second to 10 second HDMI initialization process begins. You cannot carry out any
operations during this process. The HDMI indicator in the front panel display blinks during this process, and you can turn on this receiver
once it has stopped blinking. When you set the Control with HDMI to OFF, you can skip this process. For details about the Control with HDMI
feature, see Control with HDMI function on page 57.
37
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic Setup
04
Chapter 4:
Basic Setup
Changing the OSD display language
(OSD Language)
Automatically conducting optimum
sound tuning (Full Auto MCACC)
The language used on the Graphical User Interface
The Full Auto MCACC Setup measures the acoustic
characteristics of your listening area, taking into account
ambient noise, speaker connection and speaker size, and
tests for both channel delay and channel level. After you
have set up the microphone provided with your system,
the receiver uses the information from a series of test
tones to optimize the speaker settings and equalization
for your particular room.
screen can be changed.
• The explanations in these operating instructions are
for when English is selected for the GUI screen.
1
Switch on the receiver and your TV.
Make sure that the TV’s video input is set to this receiver
(for example, if you connected this receiver to the VIDEO
jacks on your TV, make sure that the VIDEO input is now
selected).
Important
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then press
2
Press
• Make sure the microphone and speakers are not
moved during the Full Auto MCACC Setup.
HOME MENU
.
A Graphical User Interface (GUI) screen appears on your
TV. Use /// and ENTER to navigate through the
screens and select menu items. Press RETURN to exit
the current menu.
• Using the Full Auto MCACC Setup will overwrite any
existing settings for the MCACC preset you select.
• Before using the Full Auto MCACC Setup, the
headphones should be disconnected.
3
Select ‘System Setup’ from the Home Menu
.
4
Select ‘OSD Language’ from the System Setup
CAUTION
menu.
• The test tones used in the Full Auto MCACC Setup
are output at high volume.
5
Select the desired language.
Select ‘OK’ to change the language.
6
®
The setting is completed and the System Setup menu
reappears automatically.
THX
• THX is a trademark of THX Ltd., which may be
registered in some jurisdictions. All rights reserved.
1
Switch on the receiver and your TV.
Make sure that the TV’s video input is set to this receiver.
2
Connect the microphone to the MCACC SETUP MIC
jack on the front panel.
• Push down on the lower portion of the front panel
door to access the MCACC SETUP MIC jack.
38
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic Setup
04
Make sure there are no obstacles between the speakers
and the microphone.
• MCACC – The six MCACC presets are used for storing
surround sound settings for different listening
positions. Simply choose an unused preset for now
(you can rename it later in Data Management on
page 82).
AUDIO
PARAMETER
(TUNE)
VIDEO
CONTROL ON/OFF
MULTI-ZONE
TUNER EDIT
BAND AUTO SURR/ALC/ HOME STANDARD ADVANCED STEREO
SPEAKERS
STREAM DIRECT THX
SURROUND SURROUND
(PRESET)
ENTER
(TUNE)
(PRESET)
iPod
iPhone
HDMI
5
USB
MCACC
SETUP MIC
• THX Speaker – Select YES if you are using THX
speakers (set all speakers to SMALL), otherwise leave
it set to NO.
VIDEO CAMERA
PHONES
HOME MENU
RETURN
Microphone
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then select
4
Press
START
.
5
Follow the instructions on-screen.
Tripod
Make sure the microphone is connected, and if you’re
using a subwoofer, make sure it is switched on and set to
a comfortable volume level.
If you have a tripod, use it to place the microphone so that
it’s about ear level at your normal listening position. If you
do not have a tripod, use some other object to install the
6
Wait for the test tones to finish, then confirm the
speaker configuration in the GUI screen.
A progress report is displayed on-screen while the
receiver outputs test tones to determine the speakers
present in your setup. Try to be as quiet as possible while
it’s doing this.
1
microphone.
The Full Auto MCACC display appears once the
microphone is connected.
2
1a.Full Auto MCACC
A/V RECEIVER
If no operations are performed for 10 seconds while the
speaker configuration check screen is being displayed,
the Full Auto MCACC Setup will resume automatically. In
this case, you don’t need to select ‘OK’ and press ENTER
in step 7.
(
)
Speaker System
EQ Type
: Normal SB/FH
SYMMETRY
:
MCACC
: M1.MEMORY 1
THX Speaker
:
NO
START
• With error messages (such as Too much ambient
noise! or Check microphone.), select RETRY after
checking for ambient noise (see Problems when
using the Auto MCACC Setup on page 40) and
verifying the mic connection. If there doesn’t seem to
be a problem, you can simply select GO NEXT and
continue.
Exit
Return
3
Select the parameters you want to set.3
If the speakers are connected using any setup other than
Normal(SB/FH), be sure to set Speaker System before
the Full Auto MCACC Setup. See Speaker system setting
on page 85.
4
1a.Full Auto MCACC
A/V RECEIVER
1a.Full Auto MCACC
• Speaker System – Shows the current settings.
A/V RECEIVER
L
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
Now Analyzing...
2/10
FHL
C
When this is selected and ENTER is pressed, the
speaker system selection screen appears. Select the
proper speaker system, then press RETURN to return.
FHR
R
Environment Check
Ambient Noise
Microphone
SR
SBR
SBL
SL
:
:
:
OK
Speaker YES/NO
SW
10
• EQ Type – This determines how the frequency
OK
RETRY
balance is adjusted.
Exit
Cancel
Exit
Cancel
The configuration shown on-screen should reflect the
actual speakers you have.
Note
1 Install the microphone on a stable floor. Placing the microphone on any of the following surfaces may make accurate measurement
impossible:
• Sofas or other soft surfaces.
• High places such as tabletops and sofa tops.
2 If you leave the GUI screen for over five minutes, the screen saver will appear.
3 • When data measurement is taken, the reverb characteristics data (both before- and after-calibration) that this receiver had been storing will
be overwritten. If you want to save the reverb characteristics data before measuring, connect a USB memory device to this receiver and
transfer the data.
• When measurement is taken of the reverb characteristics data other than SYMMETRY, the data are not measured after the correction. If
you will need to measure after correcting data, take the measurement using the EQ Professional menu in the Manual MCACC setup (page 77).
4 If you are planning on bi-amping your front speakers, or setting up a separate speaker system in another room, read through Speaker system
setting on page 85 and make sure to connect your speakers as necessary before continuing to step 4.
39
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic Setup
04
• If you see an ERR message (or the speaker
configuration displayed isn’t correct), there may be a
problem with the speaker connection.
If selecting RETRY doesn’t work, turn off the power
and check the speaker connections. If there doesn’t
seem to be a problem, you can simply use / to
select the speaker and / to change the setting
and continue.
The Input Setup menu
You only need to make settings in the Input Setup menu
if you didn’t hook up your digital equipment according to
the default settings (see Input function default and
possible settings on page 41). In this case, you need to
tell the receiver what equipment is hooked up to which
terminal so the buttons on the remote control
• If Reverse Phase is displayed, the speaker’s wiring
correspond to the components you’ve connected.
(+ and –) may be inverted. Check the speaker
1
connections.
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then press
1
Press
– If the connections were wrong, turn off the power,
disconnect the power cord, then reconnect properly.
After this, perform the Full Auto MCACC procedure
again.
– If the connections were right, select GO NEXT and
continue.
HOME MENU
.
A Graphical User Interface (GUI) screen appears on your
TV. Use /// and ENTER to navigate through the
screens and select menu items. Press RETURN to
confirm and exit the current menu.
2
3
Select ‘System Setup’ from the Home Menu
.
7
Make sure ‘OK’ is selected, then press ENTER.
Select ‘Input Setup’ from the System Setup menu.
A progress report is displayed on-screen while the
receiver outputs more test tones to determine the
optimum receiver settings.
4.System Setup
A/V RECEIVER
4b.Input Setup
A/V RECEIVER
a.Manual SP Setup
b. Input Setup
c. OSD Language
d. Network Setup
e. Other Setup
Input
:
:
:
DVD
Rename
OFF
Input Name
Input Skip
Again, try to be as quiet as possible while this is
happening. It may take 3 to 10 minutes.
Digital In
:
:
:
:
:
COAX-1
---
HDMI Input
Component In
12V Trigger1
12V Trigger2
Comp-1
OFF
OFF
8
The Full Auto MCACC Setup procedure is completed
and the Home Menu menu reappears automatically.
Be sure to disconnect the microphone from this receiver
upon completion of the Full Auto MCACC Setup.
Exit
Return
Exit
Finish
4
Select the input function that you want to set up.
The settings made in the Full Auto MCACC Setup should
give you excellent surround sound from your system, but
it is also possible to adjust these settings manually using
The Advanced MCACC menu on page 75 or The System
The default names correspond with the names next to the
terminals on the rear panel (such as DVD or VIDEO)
which, in turn, correspond with the names on the remote
control.
2
Setup and Other Setup menus on page 84.
5
Select the input(s) to which you’ve connected your
component.
Problems when using the Auto MCACC Setup
If the room environment is not optimal for the Auto
MCACC Setup (too much background noise, echo off the
walls, obstacles blocking the speakers from the
microphone) the final settings may be incorrect. Check
for household appliances (air conditioner, fridge, fan,
etc.), that may be affecting the environment and switch
them off if necessary. If there are any instructions
showing in the front panel display, please follow them.
For example, if your DVD player only has an optical
output, you will need to change the DVD input function’s
Digital In setting from COAX-1 (default) to the optical
input you’ve connected it to. The numbering (OPT-1 to 3)
corresponds with the numbers beside the inputs on the
back of the receiver.
• Some older TVs may interfere with the operation of
the microphone. If this seems to be happening,
switch off the TV when doing the Auto MCACC Setup.
Note
1 If the speaker is not pointed to the microphone (listening position) or when using speakers that affect the phase (dipole speakers, reflective
speakers, etc.), Reverse Phase may be displayed even if the speakers are properly connected.
2 • Depending on the characteristics of your room, sometimes identical speakers with cone sizes of around 12 cm (5 inches) will end up with
different size settings. You can correct the setting manually using the Manual speaker setup on page 84.
• The subwoofer distance setting may be farther than the actual distance from the listening position. This setting should be accurate (taking
delay and room characteristics into account) and generally does not need to be changed.
• If Full Auto MCACC Setup measurement results are incorrect due to the interaction of the speakers and viewing environment, we
recommend adjusting the settings manually.
40
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic Setup
04
6
When you’re finished, proceed to the settings for
Input function default and possible settings
The terminals on the receiver generally correspond to the
name of one of the input functions. If you have connected
components to this receiver differently from (or in
addition to) the defaults below, see The Input Setup menu
on page 40 to tell the receiver how you’ve connected up.
The dots () indicate possible assignments.
other inputs.
There are optional settings in addition to the assignment
of the input jacks:
• Input Name – You can choose to rename the input
function for easier identification. Select Rename to
do so, or Default to return to the system default.
• Input Skip – When set to ON, that input is skipped
when selecting the input using INPUT SELECT. (DVD
and other inputs can be still be selected directly with
the input function buttons.)
Input Terminals
Input
function
Digital
HDMI
Component
IN 1
a
DVD
COAX-1
BD
(BD)
• 12V Trigger1/2 – After connecting a component to
one of the 12 volt triggers (see Switching components
on and off using the 12 volt trigger on page 37), select
MAIN, ZONE 2, ZONE 3 or OFF for the corresponding
trigger setting to switch it on automatically along
a
TV/SAT
DVR/BDR
VIDEO
HDMI 1
HDMI 2
HDMI 3
HDMI 4
OPT-1
OPT-2
OPT-3
a
IN 2
IN 3
a
1
(HDMI-1)
(HDMI-2)
(HDMI-3)
with the (main or sub) zone specified.
7
When you’re finished, press RETURN.
You will return to the System Setup menu.
(HDMI-4)
HDMI 5
(HDMI-5)
(front panel)
INTERNET
RADIO
iPod/USB
XM RADIO
CD
COAX-2
CD-R/TAPE
TUNER
ADAPTER
PORT
PHONO
a
MULTI CH IN
SIRIUS
a.With Control with HDMI set to ON, assignments cannot be made
(see Control with HDMI function on page 57).
Note
1 Devices connected to 12 volt triggers can be associated with HDMI OUT switching. For details, see HDMI Setup on page 57.
41
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic playback
05
Chapter 5:
Basic playback
Playing a source with HDMI connection
Playing a source
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then use
INPUT SELECT to select the HDMI input you’ve
connected to (for example, HDMI 1).
•
Press
Here are the basic instructions for playing a source (such
as a DVD disc) with your home theater system.
1
Switch on your system components and receiver.
You can also perform the same operation by using the
INPUT SELECTOR dial on the front panel or by pressing
HDMI on the remote control repeatedly.
Make sure that the TV’s video input is set to this receiver.
RECEIVER
on the remote control.
2
3
Press
• Set the HDMI parameter in Setting the Audio options
on page 60 to THROUGH if you want to hear HDMI
audio output from your TV (no sound will be heard
from this receiver).
Select the input function you want to play.
You can use the input function buttons on the remote
control, INPUT SELECT, or the front panel INPUT
SELECTOR dial.
1
• If the video signal does not appear on your TV, try
adjusting the resolution settings on your component
or display. Note that some components (such as
video game units) have resolutions that may not be
converted. In this case, use an analog video
connection.
4
Press AUTO/ALC/DIRECT (AUTO SURR/ALC/
STREAM DIRECT) to select ‘AUTO SURROUND’ and
start playback of the source.2
If you’re playing a Dolby Digital or DTS surround sound
source, you should hear surround sound. If you are
playing a stereo source, you will only hear sound from the
front left/right speakers in the default listening mode.
Selecting the multichannel analog inputs
If you have connected a decoder or a DVD player as
above, you must select the analog multichannel inputs
• See also Listening to your system on page 53 for
information on different ways of listening to sources.
3
for surround sound playback.
It is possible to check on the front panel display whether
or not multi-channel playback is being performed
properly. For details, see Auto Surround, ALC and Stream
Direct with different input signal formats on page 106.
1
Make sure you have set the playback source to the
proper output setting.
For example, you might need to set your DVD player to
output multichannel analog audio.
When using a surround back speaker, 2D+PLIIx
MOVIE is displayed when playing Dolby Digital signals,
and DTS+Neo:6 is displayed when playing DTS 5.1-
channel signals.
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then use
2
Press
INPUT SELECT to select MULTI CH IN
You can also use the INPUT SELECTOR dial on the front
panel.
.
If the display does not correspond to the input signal and
listening mode, check the connections and settings.
• Depending on the DVD player you’re using, the
analog output level of the subwoofer channel may be
too low. In this case, the output level of the subwoofer
can be increased by 10 dB in the Multi Ch In Setup
in Other Setup. For details, see Multi Channel Input
Setup on page 90.
5
Use the volume control to adjust the volume level.
Turn down the volume of your TV so that all sound is
coming from the speakers connected to this receiver.
Note
1 If you need to manually switch the input signal type press SIGNAL SEL (page 56).
2 You may need to check the digital audio output settings on your DVD player or digital satellite receiver. It should be set to output Dolby Digital,
DTS and 88.2 kHz / 96 kHz PCM (2 channel) audio, and if there is an MPEG audio option, set this to convert the MPEG audio to PCM.
3 • When playback from the multichannel inputs is selected, only the volume and channel levels can be set.
• You can’t listen to your speaker B system during playback from the multichannel inputs.
• With MULTI CH IN inputs, it is possible to play pictures simultaneously. For details, see Multi Channel Input Setup on page 90.
42
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic playback
Playing an iPod
05
4
Continue browsing until you arrive at what you
want to play, then press
to start playback.
This receiver has the iPod/iPhone/USB terminal that will
allow you to control playback of audio content from your
iPod using the controls of this receiver.
Tip
1
• You can play all of the songs in a particular category
by selecting the All item at the top of each category
list. For example, you can play all the songs by a
particular artist.
1
Switch on the receiver and your TV.
See Connecting an iPod on page 35.
• It is also possible to operate the iPod on the iPod
itself, without using the TV screen. For details, see
Switching the iPod controls on page 43.
Basic playback controls
This receiver’s remote control buttons can be used for
4
basic playback of files stored on an iPod.
2
Press iPod USB on the remote control to switch the
receiver to the iPod/USB
Loading appears in the GUI screen while the receiver
verifies the connection and retrieves data from the iPod.
.
• Press iPod USB to switch the remote control to the
iPod/USB operation mode.
DIRECT STEREO STANDARD ADV SURR
AUDIO
VIDEO
PARAMETER
PARAMETER
HDD
DVD
LIST TUNE TOOLS
When the display shows the iPod top menu you’re ready
to play music from the iPod.
THX
PHASE CTRL
STATUS
2
TOP MENU
BAND
T.EDIT
GUIDE
TV
/
DTV
MPX
PQLS
PRESET
ENTER
TUNE
PRESET
HDMI OUT
2
AUDIO
Playing back audio files stored on an iPod
1
3
CATEGORY
RETURN
To navigate songs on your iPod, you can take advantage
SIGNAL SEL MCACC SLEEP
INFO
DISP
HOME
MENU
4
5
6
3
iPod CTRL
of the GUI screen of your TV connected to this receiver.
You can also control all operations for music in the front
panel display of this receiver.
5
Switching the iPod controls
You can switch over the iPod controls between the iPod
Finding what you want to play
and the receiver.
When your iPod is connected to this receiver, you can
browse songs stored on your iPod by playlist, artist name,
album name, song name, genre or composer, similar to
using your iPod directly.
1
Press iPod CTRL to switch the iPod controls.
This enables operation and display on your iPod, and this
receiver’s remote control and GUI screen become
inactive.
1
Use / to select ‘Music’ from the iPod top menu.
2
Press iPod CTRL again to switch back to the receiver
controls.
2
Use / to select a category, then press ENTER to
browse that category.
• To return to the previous level any time, press
RETURN.
3
Use / to browse the selected category (e.g.,
albums).
• Use / to move to previous/next levels.
Note
1 • This system is compatible with the audio and video of the iPod nano (audio only for the iPod nano 1G/2G), iPod fifth generation (audio only),
iPod classic, iPod touch and iPhone. However, some of the functions may be restricted for some models. The system is not compatible with
the iPod shuffle.
•
Compatibility may vary depending on the software version of your iPod and iPhone. Please be sure to use the latest available software
version.
• iPod and iPhone are licensed for reproduction of non-copyrighted materials or materials the user is legally permitted to reproduce.
• Features such as the equalizer cannot be controlled using this receiver, and we recommend switching the equalizer off before connecting.
• Pioneer cannot under any circumstances accept responsibility for any direct or indirect loss arising from any inconvenience or loss of
recorded material resulting from the iPod failure.
• When listening to a track on the iPod in the main zone, it is possible to control the sub zone, but not to listen to a different track in the sub
zone from the one playing in the main zone.
2 The controls of your iPod will be inoperable when connected to this receiver.
3 • Note that characters that cannot be displayed on this receiver are displayed as #.
• This feature is not available for photos on your iPod. To display photos, switch iPod operation to the iPod (see Switching the iPod controls on
page 43).
4 During Audiobook playback, press / to switch the playback speed: Faster Normal Slower
5 You cannot use this function, when an iPod of fifth generation or iPod nano of first generation is connected.
43
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic playback
05
3
Continue browsing until you arrive at what you
want to play, then press
to start playback.5
Basic playback controls
Playing a USB device
1
It is possible to play files using the USB interface on the
front of this receiver.
This receiver’s remote control buttons can be used for
basic playback of files stored on USB memory devices.
1
Switch on the receiver and your TV.
2
See Connecting a USB device on page 35.
Press iPod USB on the remote control to switch the
receiver to the iPod/USB 3
• Press iPod USB to switch the remote control to the
iPod/USB operation mode.
2
DIRECT STEREO STANDARD ADV SURR
AUDIO
VIDEO
PARAMETER
PARAMETER
HDD
DVD
.
LIST TUNE TOOLS
THX
PHASE CTRL
STATUS
AUDIO
Loading appears in the GUI screen as this receiver starts
recognizing the USB device connected. When the display
shows the USB Top menu you’re ready to play from the
USB device.
TOP MENU
BAND
T.EDIT
GUIDE
TV
/
DTV
MPX
PQLS
PRESET
ENTER
TUNE
PRESET
HDMI OUT
2
1
3
CATEGORY
RETURN
SIGNAL SEL MCACC SLEEP
INFO
DISP
HOME
MENU
4
5
6
iPod CTRL
Important
Playing back photo files stored on a USB
memory device
If an Over Current message lights in the display, the
power requirements of the USB device are too high for
this receiver. Try following the points below:
6
1
Use / to select ‘Photos’ from the USB Top
• Switch the receiver off, then on again.
menu.
• Reconnect the USB device with the receiver switched
off.
2
Use / to select a folder, then press ENTER to
browse that folder.
• Use a dedicated AC adapter (supplied with the
device) for USB power.
• To return to the previous level any time, press RETURN.
3
Continue browsing until you arrive at what you
If this doesn’t remedy the problem, it is likely your USB
device is incompatible.
want to play, then press
The selected content is displayed in full screen and a
to start playback.7
slideshow starts.
Playing back audio files stored on a USB
After a slideshow launches, pressing ENTER toggles
between play and pause (only when Theme on the
Slideshow Setup is set to Normal (OFF)).
memory device
The maximum number of levels that you can select in
Step 2 (below) is 8. Also, you can display and play back
up to 30 000 folders and files within a USB memory
Basic playback controls
4
device.
Button(s) What it does
1
Use / to select ‘Music’ from the USB Top menu.
ENTER, Starts displaying a photo and playing a slideshow.
RETURN,
Stops the player and returns to the previous
menu.
2
Use / to select a folder, then press ENTER to
browse that folder.
a
• To return to the previous level any time, press
RETURN.
Displays the previous photo content.
Displays the next photo content.
Pauses/unpauses the slideshow.
Displays the photo information.
a
a
a
DISP
a.You can only use this button when Theme on the Slideshow Setup
is set to Normal (OFF)
Note
1 • Compatible USB devices include external magnetic hard drives, portable flash memory drives (particularly key drives) and digital audio
players (MP3 players) of format FAT16/32.
• Pioneer cannot guarantee compatibility (operation and/or bus power) with all USB mass storage devices and assumes no responsibility for
any loss of data that may occur when connected to this receiver.
2 Make sure the receiver is in standby when disconnecting the USB device.
3 The iPod/USB function cannot be selected in the main zone when the Internet radio function is selected in the sub zone. Also, the iPod/USB
function cannot be selected in the sub zone when the Internet radio function is selected in the main zone.
4 Note that non-Roman characters in the playlist are displayed as #.
5 • Copyrighted audio files cannot be played back on this receiver.
• DRM-protected audio files cannot be played back on this receiver.
6 Photo files cannot be played in the sub zone.
7 If the slideshow is left in the pause mode for five minutes, the list screen reappears.
44
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic playback
05
Slideshow Setup
Make the various settings for playing slideshows of photo
files here.
1
Use / to select ‘Slideshow Setup’ from the USB
Top menu.
2 Select the setting you want.
• Theme – Add various effects to the slideshow.
• Interval – Set the interval for switching the photos.
This may not be available depending on the Theme
setting.
• BGM – Play music files stored on the USB device
while displaying photos.
• Music Select – Select the folder containing the
music files to be played when BGM is set to ON.
3
When you’re finished, press RETURN.
You will return to the USB Top menu.
About playable file formats
The USB function of this receiver supports the following file formats. Note that some file formats are not available for playback
although they are listed as playable file formats.
Music files
Category Extension Stream
a
.mp3
MPEG-1, 2, 2.5 Audio Layer-3
Sampling frequency
Quantization bitrate
Channel
8 kHz to 48 kHz
16 bit
MP3
2 ch
Bitrate
8 kbps to 320 kbps
Supported/Supported
32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz
8 bit, 16 bit
VBR/CBR
WAV
.wav
LPCM
Sampling frequency
Quantization bitrate
Channel
2 ch, Monaural
8 kHz to 48 kHz
16 bit
b
WMA
.wma
Sampling frequency
Quantization bitrate
Channel
WMA8/9
2 ch
Bitrate
8 kbps to 320 kbps
Supported/Supported
VBR/CBR
a.“MPEG Layer-3 audio decoding technology licensed from Fraunhofer IIS and Thomson multimedia.”
b.Files encoded using Windows Media Codec 9 may be playable but some parts of the specification are not supported; specifically, Pro, Lossless,
Voice.
Photo files
Category Extension
JPEG
.jpg
.jpeg
.jpe
.jif
Format
Meeting the following conditions:
• Baseline JPEG format (including files recorded in Exif/DCF format)
• Y:Cb:Cr - 4:4:4, 4:2:2 or 4:2:0
Resolution
30 to 8184 pixels vertical, 40 to 8184 pixels horizontal
.jfif
45
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic playback
05
Tuning directly to a station
Listening to the radio
1
Press TUNER to select the tuner.
The following steps show you how to tune in to FM and
AM radio broadcasts using the automatic (search) and
manual (step) tuning functions. If you already know the
frequency of the station you want, see Tuning directly to a
station below. Once you are tuned to a station you can
memorize the frequency for recall later—see Saving
station presets below for more on how to do this.
2
Use BAND to change the band (FM or AM), if
necessary.
3
Press D.ACCESS (Direct Access).
Use the number buttons to enter the frequency of
4
the radio station.
For example, to tune to 106.00 (FM), press 1, 0, 6, 0, 0.
1
2
Press TUNER to select the tuner.
If you make a mistake halfway through, press D.ACCESS
twice to cancel the frequency and start over.
Use BAND to change the band (FM or AM), if
necessary.
Saving station presets
3
Tune to a station.
If you often listen to a particular radio station, it’s
convenient to have the receiver store the frequency for
easy recall whenever you want to listen to that station.
This saves the effort of manually tuning in each time. This
receiver can memorize up to 63 stations, stored in seven
banks, or classes (A to G) of 9 stations each.
There are three ways to do this:
Automatic tuning – To search for stations in the
currently selected band, press and hold TUNE /
for about a second. The receiver will start searching
for the next station, stopping when it has found one.
Repeat to search for other stations.
1
Tune to a station you want to memorize.
Manual tuning – To change the frequency one step
at a time, press TUNE /.
See Listening to the radio above for more on this.
High speed tuning – Press and hold TUNE / for
high speed tuning. Release the button at the
frequency you want.
2
Press T.EDIT TUNER EDIT).
(
The display shows PRESET MEMORY, then a blinking
memory class.
3
Press CLASS to select one of the seven classes, then
Improving FM sound
press PRESET / to select the station preset you
want.
You can also use the number buttons to select a station
preset.
If the TUNED or STEREO indicator doesn’t light when
tuning to an FM station because the signal is weak, press
MPX to switch the receiver into mono reception mode.
This should improve the sound quality and allow you to
enjoy the broadcast.
4
Press ENTER.
After pressing ENTER, the preset class and number stop
blinking and the receiver stores the station.
Using the noise cut mode
The two noise cut modes can be used when receiving AM
broadcasts. Press MPX to select the noise cut mode (1 to
2).
Listening to station presets
1
Press TUNER to select the tuner.
Using Neural Surround
This feature uses Neural Surround™ technologies to
achieve optimal surround sound from FM radio.
2
Press CLASS to select the class in which the station
is stored.
Press repeatedly to cycle through classes A to G.
• While listening to FM radio, press AUTO/ALC/
DIRECT for Neural Surround.
3
Press PRESET / to select the station preset you
want.
• You can also use the number buttons on the remote
The Neural Surround mode can be selected also with
STANDARD.
control to recall the station preset.
Naming station presets
For easier identification, you can name your station
presets.
1
Choose the station preset you want to name.
See Listening to station presets above for how to do this.
46
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic playback
05
2
Press T.EDIT
(
TUNER EDIT).
To subscribe to SIRIUS, U.S. and Canadian customers
can call 1-888-539-SIRI (1-888-539-7474) or visit
sirius.com (US) or siriuscanada.ca (Canada).
The display shows PRESET NAME, then a blinking cursor
at the first character position.
3
Input the name you want.
Use / to select a character, / to set the position,
and ENTER to confirm your selection.
Listening to XM Radio
For details on XM Radio, see About SIRIUS and XM on
page 105.
Tip
1
Press XM to switch to the XM RADIO input.
• To erase a station name, simply repeat steps 1 to 3
and input eight spaces instead of a name.
For best reception, you may need to move the XM Mini-
Tuner antenna near a window (the southernmost window
should produce the best results).
• Once you have named a station preset, you can press
DISP when listening to a station to switch the display
between name and frequency.
• If after pressing XM the display shows Check XM
Tuner or Check Antenna, try disconnecting the
receiver and tuner connections, and then plugging
1
them back in.
Listening to Satellite Radio
After connecting, you will be able to use this receiver to
select channels and navigate categories using the GUI
screen.
To listen to Satellite Radio, you’ll need to connect either
a SIRIUS or XM Satellite Radio tuner (sold separately) to
your satellite-ready receiver. Satellite Radio is available to
residents of the US (except Alaska and Hawaii) and
Canada.
2
Selecting channels and browsing by genre
From the XM Channel Guide, you can browse XM Radio
Satellite Radio delivers a variety of commercial-free
music from categories ranging from Pop, Rock, Country,
R&B, Dance, Jazz, Classical and many more plus
coverage of all the top professional and college sports
including play by play games from select leagues and
teams. Additional programming includes expert sports
talk, uncensored entertainment, comedy, family
programming, local traffic and weather and news from
your most trusted sources.
channels in the order that they appear, or you can narrow
3
your channel search by genre.
1
Press / to enter the XM Channel Guide, navigate
through the channels one at time with /, then press
ENTER to listen to the XM radio broadcast.
• To browse by genre, first press CATEGORY, use /
to select a genre, then press ENTER.
• To cancel and exit any time, press RETURN.
Whether you purchase a SIRIUS or XM tuner, you’ll need
to activate and subscribe to begin enjoying the service.
Easy to follow installation and setup instructions are
provided with the satellite tuners. Whichever service you
choose, there are a variety of programming packages
available, including the option of adding “The Best of
SIRIUS” programming to your XM tuner or “The Best of
XM” programming to your SIRIUS tuner, enabling you to
enjoy the most popular programming among both
services. The “Best of” packages are not available to
SIRIUS or XM Canada subscribers at this time.
Tip
• You can select channels directly by pressing
D.ACCESS, then the three-digit channel number.
• You can press DISP to change XM Radio information
in the front panel display.
• The currently selected channel is automatically
chosen (without pressing ENTER) after five seconds.
Using XM HD Surround
Family friendly packages are also available to restrict
channels featuring content that may be inappropriate for
children.
XM HD Surround uses Neural Surround™ technologies
to achieve optimal surround sound from XM radio. XM
HD Surround Sound is available on select XM channels
only.
To subscribe to XM, U.S. customers should visit
xmradio.com or call 1-800-XMRADIO (1-800-967-2346);
Canadian customers should visit xmradio.ca or call XM
Listener Care at 1-877-GETXMSR (1-877-438-9677).
•
While listening to XM Radio, press AUTO/ALC/
DIRECT for XM HD Surround listening.
XM HD Surround can be selected also with STANDARD.
Note
1 You can check the strength of reception in Using the XM Menu on page 48.
2 It’s easiest if you have your TV switched on to take advantage of the GUI screens. You can, however, use just the front panel display to do
everything if you prefer.
3 Select 0 (RADIO ID) from the GUI to check the Radio ID of the XM Mini-Tuner.
47
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic playback
05
• Memory Recall – Use / to browse your saved
Saving channel presets
song information (see Tip above).
This receiver can memorize up to 63 channels, stored in
1
seven banks, or classes (A to G) of 9 channels each.
3
When you’re finished press TOP MENU to return to
the reception display.
1
Select the channel you want to memorize.
See Selecting channels and browsing by genre on
page 47.
Listening to SIRIUS Radio
2
Press T.EDIT
.
For details on SIRIUS Radio, see About SIRIUS and XM on
The display shows a blinking memory class.
page 105.
3
Press CLASS to select one of the seven classes, then
1
Press SIRIUS to switch to the SIRIUS input.
press / to select the channel preset you want.
You can also use the number buttons to select a preset.
For best reception, you may need to move the
SiriusConnect™ tuner antenna near a window (refer to
the manual for the SiriusConnect™ Home tuner for
• The default for all presets is XM1.
3
4
Press ENTER.
antenna placement recommendations).
After pressing ENTER, the preset class and number stop
blinking and the receiver stores the XM channel.
• If after pressing SIRIUS the display shows Antenna
Error, try disconnecting the antenna and
4
reconnecting. If the display shows Check Sirius
Tip
Tuner, check the connection of the AC adapter and
this receiver to the SiriusConnect™ tuner.
• You can also press MEMORY during reception
display to save the information of up to five songs.
See Using the XM Menu below to recall this
information.
After connecting, you will be able to use this receiver to
select channels and navigate categories using the GUI
5
screen display.
Listening to channel presets
Selecting channels and browsing by genre
From the SIRIUS Channel Guide, you can browse SIRIUS
Radio channels in the order that they appear, or you can
narrow your channel search by genre.
1
Press CLASS to select the class in which the channel
is stored.
Press repeatedly to cycle through classes A to G.
2
Press / to select the channel preset you want.
• You can also use the number buttons on the remote
control to recall the channel preset.
1
Press / to enter the SIRIUS Channel Guide,
navigate through the channels one at time with /
then press ENTER to listen to the SIRIUS radio
broadcast.
,
Using the XM Menu
The XM Menu provides additional XM Radio features.
• To browse by genre, first press CATEGORY, use /
to select a genre, then press ENTER.
2
• To cancel and exit any time, press RETURN.
1
Press TOP MENU
.
2
Use / to select a menu item, then press ENTER
.
Tip
Choose from the following menu items:
• You can select channels directly by pressing
D.ACCESS, then the three-digit channel number.
• Channel Skip/Add – Use / and ENTER to select
channels you would like to remove/restore from/to
the channel guide.
• You can press DISP to change SIRIUS Radio
information in the front panel display.
• Antenna Aiming – Check the strength of satellite
and terrestrial reception.
Note
1 You can reset the channel presets and memory in Resetting the system on page 66.
2 You can reset the Channel Skip/Add settings in Resetting the system on page 66.
3 • In order to activate your radio subscription, you will need the SIRIUS ID (SID) which uniquely identifies your tuner. The SID may be found on
a sticker located on the packaging, or on the bottom of the tuner itself. The label will have a printed 12-digit SID number. When you have
located the SID, write it down in the space provided near the end of this manual. Contact SIRIUS on the internet at: https://
activate.siriusradio.com
Follow the prompts to activate your subscription, or you can also call SIRIUS toll-free at 1-888-539-SIRIUS (1-888-539-7474).
• Select 0 (SIRIUS ID) from the on-screen display to check the Radio ID of the SiriusConnect™ tuner (see Selecting channels and browsing by
genre on page 48).
4 You can check the strength of reception in Using the SIRIUS Menu on page 49.
5 It’s easiest if you have your TV switched on to take advantage of the GUI screens. You can, however, use just the front panel display to do
everything if you prefer.
48
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic playback
05
• The currently selected channel is automatically
chosen (without pressing ENTER) after five seconds.
• Parental Lock – Use / and ENTER to select
channels you would like to place under parental lock.
Channels put under parental lock are not displayed in
the Channel Guide, but may be accessed by directly
inputting their channel number and providing the
parental lock password.
Saving channel presets
This receiver can memorize up to 63 channels, stored in
seven banks, or classes (A to G) of nine channels each.
1
• Antenna Aiming – Check the strength of satellite
and terrestrial reception.
1
Select the channel you want to memorize.
See Selecting channels and browsing by genre on
page 48.
• Memory Recall – Use / to browse your saved
song information (see Tip above).
2
Press T.EDIT
.
• Password Set – Set the parental lock password.
The display shows a blinking memory class.
3
When you’re finished press TOP MENU to return to
3
Press CLASS to select one of the seven classes, then
the reception display.
press / to select the channel preset you want.
You can also use the number buttons to select a preset.
4
Press ENTER.
Listening to Internet radio stations
After pressing ENTER, the preset class and number stop
blinking and the receiver stores the SIRIUS channel.
Internet radio is an audio broadcasting service
3
transmitted via the Internet. There are a large number of
Internet radio stations broadcasting a variety of services
from every corner of the world. Some are hosted,
managed, and broadcast by private individuals while
others are by the corresponding traditional terrestrial
radio stations or radio networks. Whereas terrestrial, or
OTA (over-the-air), radio stations are geographically
restricted on the range of radio waves broadcast from a
transmitter through the air, Internet radio stations are
accessible from anywhere in the world, as long as there
is a connection to the Internet, as services are not
transmitted through the air but are delivered over the
World Wide Web. On this receiver you can select Internet
radio stations by genre as well as by region.
Tip
• You can also press MEMORY during reception
display to save the information of up to five songs.
See Using the SIRIUS Menu below to recall this
information.
Listening to channel presets
1
Press CLASS to select the class in which the channel
is stored.
Press repeatedly to cycle through classes A to G.
2
Press / to select the channel preset you want.
• You can also use the number buttons on the remote
control to recall the channel preset.
Important
• Before listening to Internet radio, you need to
program the Internet radio stations you wish to listen
to onto this unit. See Programming the Internet radio
stations on page 50 for how to program. Though the
Internet radio stations are programmed in this
receiver before it leaves the factory, the link may have
expired. In that case, preset the stations again
yourself.
Using the SIRIUS Menu
The SIRIUS Menu provides additional SIRIUS Radio
2
features.
1
Press TOP MENU
.
2
Use / to select a menu item, then press ENTER
.
Choose from the following menu items:
• Channel Skip/Add – Use / and ENTER to select
channels you would like to remove/restore from/to
the channel guide.
1
Press NET RADIO to switch to the Internet radio
input.4
The Internet Radio list screen is displayed.
Note
1 You can reset the Channel presets and memory in Resetting the system on page 66.
2 You can reset the Channel Skip/Add, Parental Lock and Password settings in Resetting the system on page 66.
3 • To listen to Internet radio stations, you must have high-speed broadband Internet access. With a 56 K or ISDN modem, you may not enjoy
the full benefits of Internet radio.
• The port number varies depending on the Internet radio station. Check the firewall settings.
• Broadcasts may be stopped or interrupted depending on the Internet radio station. In this case, you cannot listen to a radio station selected
from the list of Internet radio stations.
4 The Internet radio function cannot be selected in the main zone when the iPod/USB function is selected in the sub zone. Also, the Internet
radio function cannot be selected in the sub zone when the iPod/USB function is selected in the main zone.
49
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic playback
05
2
Use / to select the Internet radio station to play
When the connection is made with the receiver, a Top
Menu will be displayed.
back, and then press ENTER
.
Press / to scroll up and down the list and select the
desired item. When you press ENTER, playback starts
with the playback screen being displayed for the selected
item. Depending on the Internet line conditions, the
sound may not be smooth when playing Internet radio.
• This receiver’s IP address can be found in the ‘IP
address, Proxy’ menu (page 87).
3
Select ‘Internet Radio Setting’.
The following programming screen will be shown on the
browser.
1
To return to the list screen, press RETURN.
T
T
o
o
p
p
Menu
Menu
Pioneer
Internet Radio Setting
Programming the Internet radio stations
By programming the Internet radio stations you wish to
listen to onto this receiver, you will be able to select those
Internet radio stations. You can program up to 24
stations.
J-POP
Title
1
Update
Update
Update
Update
Update
Update
Update
Update
Connection OK
Connection OK
Connection OK
Connection OK
Connection OK
Connection OK
Connection OK
Connection OK
http://www.xxxxxxx.net:9500
URL
Title
URL
Title
URL
Title
URL
Title
URL
Title
URL
Title
URL
Title
URL
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Rock
http://www.xxxxxxx.com:8096
Classic
http://www.yyyyyyy.com:8800
STATION6
http://zzzzzzz.com:7040
ENKA
http://www.zyxzyx.com:6000
There are two methods of programming: one lets you use
the GUI screen on this receiver; the other lets you
connect your computer and use that screen.
4
Enter the title and URL of the Internet radio station
you wish to program, then press ‘Update’.
The entered information will be transmitted to the
receiver.
Programming with the GUI screen
1
Press TOP MENU when the Internet Radio station
The connection to the URL designated from the
computer will be confirmed:
list is displayed.
The Internet Radio Setup screen is displayed.
If connection is successful, ‘Connection OK’ will be
displayed on screen, and the selected Internet radio
station will begin playing via this receiver.
2
Use / to select the Internet Radio station list
screen you wish to edit, and then press ENTER
.
3
Use / to select “Edit“.
If the connection failed, ‘Connection NG’ will be
• If you select “Delete”, information regarding the
Internet radio stations programmed into the currently
selected memory will be deleted.
displayed. Check to see if the URL you entered is correct.
Important
4
Enter the URL of the Internet radio station you wish
• ‘Connection OK’ and ‘Connection NG’ are only
displayed when this receiver is set to the Internet
radio function.
to program.2
Use / to select a letter and / to move the cursor.
• A URL containing up to 192 letters can be entered.
• When entering the title and URL of Internet radio
station, do not press ‘Update’ while you are
connected to other stations (i.e., labelled as
“Connecting...”).
5
Enter the title of the Internet radio station.
Use / to select a letter and / to move the cursor.
• A title containing up to 22 letters can be entered.
Programming on the computer screen
You can enter the Internet radio list on the screen of a
computer that is connected to the same LAN as this
receiver, and send the list to this unit.
The computer needs to be connected in advance to the
network of this receiver and set up.
1
Turn on the computer and launch the Internet
browser.
2
In the address bar on the browser, enter the IP
address assigned to this receiver.
For example, if the IP address of this receiver is
“192.168.0.2”, enter “http://192.168.0.2/”.
Note
1 When the list screen is displayed from the playback screen, the playback screen reappears automatically if no operation is performed for 10
seconds while the list screen is displayed.
2 The URL can also be entered by connecting a USB keyboard (see Connecting a USB device on page 35).
50
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic playback
05
Pairing the Bluetooth ADAPTER and Bluetooth
wireless technology device
Bluetooth ADAPTER for Wireless
Enjoyment of Music
“Pairing” must be done before you start playback of
Bluetooth wireless technology content using the
Bluetooth ADAPTER. Make sure to perform pairing the
first time you operate the system or any time pairing data
is cleared. The pairing step is necessary to register the
Bluetooth wireless technology device to enable Bluetooth
Device not
equipped with
Bluetooth wireless
technology:
Digital music
player
+
3
communications. For more details, see also the
Bluetooth wireless
technology
Bluetooth
operating instructions of your Bluetooth wireless
technology device.
wireless
enabled device:
Digital music
player
Bluetooth audio
transmitter
(sold commercially)
technology
enabled device:
cell phone
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then press
1
Press
HOME MENU
.
2
3
4
Select ‘System Setup’, then press ENTER
Select ‘Other Setup’, then press ENTER
Select ‘Pairing Bluetooth Device’, then press
.
.
ENTER
.
Bluetooth®
ADAPTER
Music data
This receiver
5
Select the ‘Passcode’ setting you want.
Select the same passcode as the Bluetooth wireless
technology device you wish to connect.
• 0000/1234/8888 – Select the passcode from these
options. These are the passcodes that can be used in
most cases.
• Others – Select to use a passcode other than those
mentioned above.
6
If you selected Others in step 5, enter the passcode.
Remote control
operation
Use / to select a number and / to move the
cursor.
7
Follow the instructions displayed on the GUI screen
Wireless music play
to conduct pairing with the Bluetooth wireless
technology device.
Switch on the Bluetooth wireless technology device that
you want to make pair, place it near the receiver and set
it to the pairing mode.
When the Bluetooth ADAPTER (Pioneer Model No. AS-
1
BT100) is connected to this unit, a product equipped
with Bluetooth wireless technology (portable cell phone,
digital music player, etc.) can be used to listen to music
wirelessly. Also, by using a commercially available
transmitter supporting Bluetooth wireless technology,
you can listen to music on a device not equipped with
Bluetooth wireless technology. The AS-BT100 model
supports SCMS-T contents protection, so music can also
be enjoyed on devices equipped with SCMS-T type
Bluetooth wireless technology.
8
Check to see that the Bluetooth ADAPTER is
detected by the Bluetooth wireless technology device.
When the Bluetooth wireless technology device is
connected:
4
CONNECTED appears in the receiver display.
When the Bluetooth wireless technology device is not
connected:
Remote control operation
Go back to the passcode setting in step 5. In this case,
perform the connection operation from the Bluetooth
wireless technology device.
The remote control supplied with this unit allows you to
play and stop media, and perform other operations.
2
Note
1 The Bluetooth ADAPTER (AS-BT100) is sold separately.
2 • It must be necessary that the Bluetooth wireless technology enabled device supports AVRCP profiles.
• Remote control operations cannot be guaranteed for all Bluetooth wireless technology enabled devices.
3 • Pairing is required when you first use the Bluetooth wireless technology device and Bluetooth ADAPTER.
• To enable Bluetooth communication, pairing should be done with both your system and Bluetooth wireless technology device.
4 The system can display alphanumeric characters only. Other characters may not be displayed correctly.
51
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Basic playback
05
9
From the Bluetooth wireless technology device list,
select Bluetooth ADAPTER and enter the Passcode
selected in step 5.1
Listening to music contents of a Bluetooth
wireless technology device with your system
1
Press ADAPTER on the remote control to switch the
receiver to ADAPTER PORT input.2
From the Bluetooth wireless technology device,
2
perform the operation to connect to the Bluetooth
ADAPTER.
3
Start playback of music contents stored on the
Bluetooth wireless technology device.
This receiver’s remote control buttons can be used for
basic playback of files stored on Bluetooth wireless
3
technology devices.
DIRECT STEREO STANDARD ADV SURR
HDD
DVD
THX
PHASE CTRL
STATUS
AUDIO
TV
/
DTV
MPX
PQLS
3
HDMI OUT
2
1
®
The Bluetooth word mark and logos are registered
trademarks owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and any use of
such marks by Pioneer Corporation is under license.
Other trademarks and trade names are those of their
respective owners.
Note
1 The passcode may in some cases be referred to as PASSKEY or PIN code.
2 When the Bluetooth ADAPTER is not plugged into the ADAPTER PORT, NO ADAPTER will be displayed if ADAPTER PORT input is selected.
3 • Bluetooth wireless technology device should be compatible with AVRCP profile.
• Depending on the Bluetooth wireless technology device you use, operation may differ from what is shown in the remote control buttons.
52
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Listening to your system
06
Chapter 6:
Listening to your system
Important
Listening in surround sound
• The listening modes and many features described in
this section may not be available depending on the
current source, settings and status of the receiver.
Using this receiver, you can listen to any source in
surround sound. However, the options available will
depend on your speaker setup and the type of source
you’re listening to.
Auto playback
Standard surround sound
The following modes provide basic surround sound for
stereo and multichannel sources.
There are many ways to listen back to sources using this
receiver, but the simplest, most direct listening option is
the Auto Surround feature. The receiver automatically
detects what kind of source you’re playing and selects
multichannel or stereo playback as necessary.
RECEIVER
on the remote control.
1
2
Press
While listening to a source, press STANDARD
RECEIVER
on the remote control.
1
2
Press
(STANDARD SURROUND).
If necessary, press repeatedly to select a listening mode.
While listening to a source, press AUTO/ALC/
DIRECT
playback of a source.
AUTO SURROUND shows briefly in the display before
showing the decoding or playback format. Check the
digital format indicators in the front panel display to see
how the source is being processed.
(
AUTO SURR ALC STREAM DIRECT) for auto
/
/
• If the source is Dolby Digital, DTS, or Dolby Surround
encoded, the proper decoding format will
automatically be selected and shows in the display.
1
With two channel sources, you can select from:
• 2 Pro Logic IIx MOVIE – Up to 7.1 channel sound
(surround back), especially suited to movie sources
• If the source is Dolby Digital, DTS, or Dolby Surround
encoded, the proper decoding format will
automatically be selected and shows in the display.
• 2 Pro Logic IIx MUSIC – Up to 7.1 channel sound
2
(surround back), especially suited to music sources
• 2 Pro Logic IIx GAME – Up to 7.1 channel sound
(surround back), especially suited to video games
• When listening to the FM radio, the Neural Surround
feature is selected automatically (see Using Neural
Surround on page 46 for more on this).
• 2 PRO LOGIC – 4.1 channel surround sound (sound
from the surround speakers is mono)
• When listening to the ADAPTER PORT input, the
SOUND RETRIEVER AIR feature is selected
automatically (see Listening in stereo on page 55 for
more on this).
• 2 Pro Logic IIz HEIGHT – Up to 7.1 channel sound
3
(front height)
•
WIDE SURROUND MOVIE – Up to 7.1 channel sound
(front wide), especially suited to movie sources4
• When listening to XM Radio, the XM HD Surround
feature is selected automatically (see Using XM HD
Surround on page 47 for more on this).
• WIDE SURROUND MUSIC – Up to 7.1 channel sound
4
(front wide), especially suited to music sources
ALC – In the Auto level control (ALC) mode, this receiver
equalizes playback sound levels.
• Neo:6 CINEMA – 7.1 channel sound (surround
5
back), especially suited to movie sources
• Neo:6 MUSIC – 7.1 channel sound (surround back),
especially suited to music sources
Tip
5
• When ALC is selected, the effect level can be
adjusted using the EFFECT parameter in Setting the
Audio options on page 60.
Note
1 If the surround back speakers are not connected or V.SB is switched OFF (page 61), 2 Pro Logic IIx becomes 2 Pro Logic II (5.1 channel
sound).
2 When listening to 2-channel sources in Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music mode, there are three further parameters you can adjust: C.WIDTH,
DIMENSION and PANORAMA. See Setting the Audio options on page 60 to adjust them.
3 • This mode can only be selected when Speaker System is set to Normal(SB/FH).
• When listening sources in 2 Pro Logic IIz HEIGHT mode, you can also adjust the H.GAIN effect (see Setting the Audio options on page 60).
4 This mode can only be selected when Speaker System is set to Normal(SB/FW).
5 When listening to 2-channel sources in Neo:6 Cinema or Neo:6 Music mode, you can also adjust the center image effect (see Setting the Audio
options on page 60).
53
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Listening to your system
06
• Neural Surround – Up to 7.1 channel sound
(surround back), especially suited to music sources
• Neo:6 CINEMA+THX CINEMA
• 2 Pro Logic IIx MUSIC+THX MUSIC
• Neo:6 MUSIC+THX MUSIC
1
• XM HD Surround – Up to 7.1 channel sound,
2
especially suited to music sources
• 2 Pro Logic IIx GAME+THX GAMES
With multichannel sources, if you have connected
surround back, front height or front wide speakers, you can
select (according to format):
3
• 2 Pro Logic IIz HEIGHT+THX CINEMA
3
• 2 Pro Logic IIz HEIGHT+THX MUSIC
• 2 Pro Logic IIx MOVIE – See above
3
• 2 Pro Logic IIz HEIGHT+THX GAMES
• 2 Pro Logic IIx MUSIC – See above
5
• THX SELECT2 GAMES
• Dolby Digital EX – Creates surround back channel
sound for 5.1 channel sources and provides pure
decoding for 6.1 channel sources (like Dolby Digital
Surround EX)
With multichannel sources, press THX (HOME THX)
repeatedly to select from:
• THX CINEMA
• THX MUSIC
• THX GAMES
• DTS-ES – Allows you to hear 6.1 channel playback
with DTS-ES encoded sources
• DTS Neo:6 – Allows you to hear 6.1 channel playback
with DTS encoded sources
• THX Surround EX – Allows you to hear 6.1 or 7.1
channel playback with 5.1 channel sources
3
• Neo:6 CINEMA+THX CINEMA
• 2 Pro Logic IIz HEIGHT – See above
4
• 2 Pro Logic IIx MOVIE+THX CINEMA
• WIDE SURROUND MOVIE – See above
5
• THX SELECT2 CINEMA – Allows you to hear 7.1
channel playback with 5.1 channel sources
4
• WIDE SURROUND MUSIC – See above
• Straight Decode – Plays back without the effects
• 2 Pro Logic IIx MUSIC+THX MUSIC
above.
3
• 2 Pro Logic IIz HEIGHT+THX CINEMA
Using the Home THX modes
3
• 2 Pro Logic IIz HEIGHT+THX MUSIC
THX and Home THX are technical standards created by
THX Ltd. for cinema and home theater sound. Home THX
is designed to make home theater audio sound more like
what you hear in a cinema.
3
• 2 Pro Logic IIz HEIGHT+THX GAMES
5
•
THX SELECT2 MUSIC – This mode is suited not only
for sources recorded in Dolby Digital and DTS, but also
to all multi-channel music sources (DVD-Audio, etc.).
5
Different THX options will be available depending on the
source and the setting for surround back channel
processing (see THX Audio Setting on page 87 for more
on this).
• THX SELECT2 GAMES – This mode is suited to
playing the sound of games.
Using the Advanced surround effects
RECEIVER
1
•
Press
on the remote control.
The Advanced surround effects can be used for a variety of
additional surround sound effects. Most Advanced Surround
modes are designed to be used with film soundtracks, but
some modes are also suited for music sources. Try different
settings with various soundtracks to see which you like.
Press THX
(HOME THX) to select a listening mode.
With two channel sources, press THX repeatedly to select
a matrix-decoding process for the THX CINEMA mode
(see THX Audio Setting on page 87 for an explanation of
each process):
RECEIVER
1
2
Press
on the remote control.
ADVANCED SURROUND
• THX CINEMA
Press ADV SURR
(
)
• THX MUSIC
repeatedly to select a listening mode.
• ACTION – Designed for action movies with dynamic
• THX GAMES
• 2 Pro Logic IIx MOVIE+THX CINEMA
• 2 PRO LOGIC+THX CINEMA
soundtracks
• DRAMA – Designed for movies with lots of dialog
Note
1 Neural Surround can be selected for 2-channel signals for which the input signal is PCM (48 kHz or less), Dolby Digital, DTS or analog 2-
channel sources.
2 XM HD Surround can be selected only with the XM input.
3 • This mode can only be selected when Speaker System is set to Normal(SB/FH).
• When listening sources in 2 Pro Logic IIz HEIGHT mode, you can also adjust the H.GAIN effect (see Setting the Audio options on page 60).
4 This mode can only be selected when Speaker System is set to Normal(SB/FW).
5 Unavailable with only one surround back speaker connected or not connected.
54
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Listening to your system
06
• SCI-FI – Designed for science fiction with lots of
special effects
Using Front Stage Surround Advance
• MONO FILM – Creates surround sound from mono
soundtracks
The Front Stage Surround Advance function allows you to
create natural surround sound effects using just the front
speakers and the subwoofer.
• ENT.SHOW – Suitable for musical sources
• EXPANDED – Creates an extra wide stereo field
RECEIVER
on the remote control.
1
2
Press
• TV SURROUND – Provides surround sound for both
mono and stereo TV sources
While listening to a source, press STEREO to select
Front Stage Surround Advance modes.
• STEREO – See Listening in stereo above for more on
this.
• ADVANCED GAME – Suitable for video games
• SPORTS – Suitable for sports programs
• CLASSICAL – Gives a large concert hall-type sound
• F.S.SURR FOCUS – Use to provide a rich surround
sound effect directed to the center of where the front
left and right speakers sound projection area
converges.
• ROCK/POP – Creates a live concert sound for rock
and/or pop music
• UNPLUGGED – Suitable for acoustic music sources
• F.S.SURR WIDE – Use to provide a surround sound
effect to a wider area than FOCUS mode.
• EXT.STEREO – Gives multichannel sound to a stereo
source, using all of your speakers
FOCUS position
WIDE position
• PHONES SURR – When listening through
headphones, you can still get the effect of overall
surround.
(Recommended)
Frontright Front left
speaker speaker
Frontright
speaker
Front left
speaker
Tip
• When an Advanced Surround listening mode is
selected, the effect level can be adjusted using the
EFFECT parameter in Setting the Audio options on
page 60.
Listening in stereo
Using Stream Direct
When you select STEREO, you will hear the source
through just the front left and right speakers (and
possibly your subwoofer depending on your speaker
settings). Multichannel sources are downmixed to
stereo.
Use the Stream Direct modes when you want to hear the
truest possible reproduction of a source. All unnecessary
signal processing is bypassed, and you’re left with the
pure analog or digital sound source. Processing differs
depending on the input signal and whether or not
surround back speakers are connected. For details, see
Auto Surround, ALC and Stream Direct with different input
signal formats on page 106.
RECEIVER
on the remote control.
1
2
Press
While listening to a source, press STEREO for stereo
playback.
Press repeatedly to switch between:
RECEIVER
on the remote control.
1
2
Press
While listening to a source, press AUTO/ALC/
• STEREO – The audio is heard with your sound
settings and you can still use the audio options.
DIRECT
(
AUTO SURR ALC STREAM DIRECT) to select
/
/
the mode you want.
Check the digital format indicators in the front panel
display to see how the source is being processed.
• F.S.SURR FOCUS – See Using Front Stage Surround
Advance below for more on this.
• F.S.SURR WIDE – See Using Front Stage Surround
Advance below for more on this.
• AUTO SURROUND – See Auto playback on page 53.
• ALC – Listening in Auto level control mode (page 53).
1
• SOUND RETRIEVER AIR – Suitable for listening to
the sound from a Bluetooth wireless technology
device.
• DIRECT – Plays back sound from the source with the
least modification next to PURE DIRECT. With
DIRECT, the only modifications added to PURE
DIRECT playback are calibration of the sound field by
the MCACC system and the Phase Control effect.
Note
1 The SOUND RETRIEVER AIR listening mode can only selected when the ADAPTER PORT input.
55
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Listening to your system
06
4
• PURE DIRECT – Plays back unmodified sound from
source with only minimal digital treatment. No sound
is output from the Speaker B in this mode.
• PCM – For PCM input signals. The receiver selects
the first available signal in the following order: HDMI;
DIGITAL.
When set to DIGITAL, HDMI or AUTO (only selected
DIGITAL or HDMI), the indicators light according to the
signal being decoded (see Display on page 12).
Selecting MCACC presets
• Default setting: MEMORY 1
If you have calibrated your system for different listening
positions, you can switch between settings to suit the
kind of source you’re listening to and where you’re sitting
(for example, watching movies from a sofa, or playing a
video game close to the TV).
Better sound using Phase Control
This receiver’s Phase Control feature uses phase
correction measures to make sure your sound source
arrives at the listening position in phase, preventing
unwanted distortion and/or coloring of the sound.
RECEIVER
on the remote control.
1
2
Press
Phase Control technology provides coherent sound
reproduction through the use of phase matching for an
optimal sound image. The default setting is on and we
recommend leaving Phase Control switched on for all
sound sources.
5
While listening to a source, press MCACC
.
1
Press repeatedly to select one of the six MCACC presets .
See Data Management on page 82 to check and manage
your current settings.
RECEIVER
1
•
Press
on the remote control.
PHASE CONTROL) to switch on
Choosing the input signal
Press PHASE CTRL
(
phase correction.
The PHASE CONTROL indicator on the front panel lights.
On this receiver, it is possible to switch the input signals
2
for the different inputs as described below.
RECEIVER
on the remote control.
1
2
Press
Press SIGNAL SEL to select the input signal
corresponding to the source component.
Each press cycles through the options as follows:
• AUTO – The receiver selects the first available signal
in the following order: HDMI; DIGITAL; ANALOG.
• ANALOG – Selects an analog signal.
• DIGITAL – Selects an optical or coaxial digital signal.
3
• HDMI – Selects an HDMI signal.
Note
1 • These settings have no effect when headphones are connected.
• You can also press / to select the MCACC preset.
2 • This receiver can only play back Dolby Digital, PCM (32 kHz to 192 kHz), DTS (including DTS 96/24) and WMA9 Pro digital signal formats.
The compatible signals via the HDMI terminals are: Dolby Digital, DTS, WMA9 Pro, PCM (32 kHz to 192 kHz), Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus,
DTS-EXPRESS, DTS-HD Master Audio and SACD.
• You may get digital noise when an LD, CD, DVD or BD player compatible with DTS is playing an analog signal. To prevent noise, make the
proper digital connections (page 29) and set the signal input to DIGITAL.
• Some DVD players don’t output DTS signals. For more details, refer to the instruction manual supplied with your DVD player.
3 When the HDMI audio output parameter is set to THROUGH, the sound will be heard through your TV, not from this receiver.
4 • This is useful if you find there is a slight delay before AUTO recognizes the PCM signal on a CD, for instance.
• When PCM is selected, noise may be output during playback of non-PCM sources. Please select another input signal if this is a problem.
5 • Phase matching is a very important factor in achieving proper sound reproduction. If two waveforms are ‘in phase’, they crest and trough
together, resulting in increased amplitude, clarity and presence of the sound signal. If a crest of a wave meets a trough, then the sound will
be ‘out of phase’ and an unreliable sound image will be produced.
• The PHASE CONTROL feature is available even when the headphones are plugged in.
• If your subwoofer has a phase control switch, set it to the plus (+) sign (or 0°). However, the effect you can actually feel when
PHASE CONTROL is set to ON on this receiver depends on the type of your subwoofer. Set your subwoofer to maximize the effect. It is also
recommended you try changing the orientation or the place of your subwoofer.
• Set the built-in lowpass filter switch of your subwoofer to off. If this cannot be done on your subwoofer, set the cutoff frequency to a higher
value.
• If the speaker distance is not properly set, you may not have a maximized PHASE CONTROL effect.
• The PHASE CONTROL mode cannot be set to ON in the following cases:
– When the PURE DIRECT mode is switched on.
– When MULTI CH IN input is selected.
– When the HDMI audio output parameter is set to THROUGH in Setting the Audio options on page 60.
56
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Control with HDMI function
Chapter 7:
07
Control with HDMI function
Synchronized operations below with a Control with
HDMI-compatible Pioneer TV or Blu-ray disc player or
Important
with a component of another make that supports the
Control with HDMI functions are possible when the
component is connected to the receiver using an HDMI
cable.
• When connecting this system or changing
connections, be sure to switch the power off and
disconnect the power cord from the wall socket.
After completing all connections, connect the power
cords to the wall socket.
• The receiver’s volume can be set and the sound can
be muted using the TV’s remote control.
• After this receiver is connected to an AC outlet, a 2
second to 10 second HDMI initialization process
begins. You cannot carry out any operations during
initialization. The HDMI indicator on the display unit
blinks during initialization, and you can turn this
receiver on once it has stopped blinking.
• The receiver’s input switches over automatically
when the TV’s channel is changed or a Control with
HDMI-compatible component is played.
• The receiver’s power is also set to standby, when the
TV’s power is set to standby.
• To get the most out of this function, we recommend
that you connect your HDMI component not to a TV but
rather directly to the HDMI terminal on this receiver.
Important
• With Pioneer devices, the Control with HDMI
functions are referred to as “KURO LINK”.
• While the receiver is equipped with six HDMI inputs
(BD, HDMI 1 to 5), the Control with HDMI function
can only be used with up to three DVD or Blu-ray disc
players or up to three DVD or Blu-ray disc recorders.
• You cannot use this function with components that
do not support Control with HDMI.
• The Control with HDMI function can be used with a
TV connected to the HDMI OUT 1 terminal, but not
with a TV connected to the HDMI OUT 2 terminal.
• We do not guarantee this receiver will work with
Pioneer Control with HDMI-compatible components
or components of other makes that support the
Control with HDMI function. We do not guarantee
that all synchronized operations will work with
components of other makes that support the Control
with HDMI function.
HDMI Setup
You must adjust the settings of this receiver as well as the
connected Control with HDMI-compatible components
in order to make use of the Control with HDMI function.
For more information see the operating instructions for
each component.
®
• Use a High Speed HDMI cable when you want to
use the Control with HDMI function. The Control
with HDMI function may not work properly if a
different type of HDMI cable is used.
• For details about concrete operations, settings, etc.,
refer to also the operating instructions for each
component.
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then press
1
Press
HOME MENU
.
2
Select ‘System Setup’, then press ENTER
.
3
4
Select ‘Other Setup’, then press ENTER
.
Making Control with HDMI
connections
Select ‘HDMI Setup’, then press ENTER
Select the ‘Control’ setting you want.
.
5
You can use synchronized operation for a connected TV
Choose whether to set this unit’s Control with HDMI
function ON or OFF. You will need to set it to ON to use
the Control with HDMI function.
and up to five other components.
• Be sure to connect the TV’s audio cable to the audio
input of this unit. When the TV and receiver are
connected by HDMI connections, if the TV supports
the HDMI Audio Return Channel function, the sound
of the TV is input to the receiver via the HDMI OUT 1
terminal, so there is no need to connect an audio
cable. In this case, set TV Audio at HDMI Setup to
via HDMI (see HDMI Setup on page 57).
When using a component that does not support the
Control with HDMI function, set this to OFF.
• ON – Enables the Control with HDMI function. When
this unit’s power is turned off and you have a
supported source begin playback while using the
Control with HDMI function, the audio and video
outputs from the HDMI connection are output from
the TV.
For details, see Connecting your TV and playback
components on page 24.
57
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Control with HDMI function
07
• OFF – The Control with HDMI is disabled.
Synchronized operations cannot be used. When this
unit’s power is turned off, audio and video of sources
connected via HDMI are not output.
Before using synchronization
Once you have finished all connections and settings, you
must:
6
Select the ‘Control Mode’ setting you want.
1
Put all components into standby mode.
Choose whether you want to enable HDMI for all linked
functions or the PQLS function only. However, Display
Power Off will activate the settings set forth in step 7
below.
2
Turn the power on for all components, with the
power for the TV being turned on last.
3
Choose the HDMI input to which the TV is
• ALL – Enabled for all linked functions.
connected to this receiver, and see if video output from
connected components displays properly on the screen
or not.
• PQLS – Enabled only for the PQLS function. When
PQLS is selected, link functions other than the PQLS
function may not work properly. If you wish to use all
link functions, select ALL.
4
Check whether the components connected to all
HDMI inputs are properly displayed.
7
Select the ‘Display Power Off’ setting you want.
If the TV’s power is turned off while using the Control
with HDMI function, the receiver’s power is also turned
off (all power off function). This function can be disabled.
About synchronized operations
The Control with HDMI-compatible component
connected to the receiver operates in sync as described
below.
•
YES – The all power off function is enabled. The
receiver’s power turns off together with the TV’s power.
This function only works when the input for a
component connected to the receiver by HDMI
connection is selected or when watching the TV.
• From the menu screen of the Control with HDMI-
compatible TV, set audio to be played through this
receiver, and the receiver will switch to the
synchronized amp mode.
• NO – The all power off function is disabled. The
receiver’s power is not affected when the TV’s power
is turned off.
• When in the synchronized amp mode, you can adjust
the receiver’s volume or mute the sound using the
TV’s remote control.
8
Select the ‘Standby Through’ setting you want.
It is possible to transfer signals from an HDMI-connected
player to the TV when this receiver's power is on standby
as long as Control is ON, but the amount of energy
consumed rises. It is, however, possible to minimize
energy consumption when power is set to standby.
• When in the synchronized amp mode, the
synchronized amp mode is canceled when the
receiver’s power is turned off. To turn the
synchronized amp mode back on, set audio to be
played through the receiver from the TV’s menu
screen, etc. This receiver will power up and switch to
the synchronized amp mode.
• Normal – Regular setting. Power-up time from
standby is short.
• When the synchronized amp mode is canceled, the
receiver’s power turns off if you were viewing an
HDMI input or a TV program on the TV.
• Eco – Conserves energy while standby. Power-up
time is longer than when set to Normal.
9
Select the ‘TV Audio’ setting you want.
• When in the synchronized amp mode, the
synchronized amp mode is canceled if an operation
that produces sound from the TV is performed from
the TV’s menu screen, etc.
When a TV supporting the HDMI Audio Return Channel
function is connected to the receiver, the sound of the TV
can be input via the HDMI terminal.
• Normal – The TV’s sound is input from the Audio
input terminals other than HDMI inputs.
• When the TV’s power is set to standby, the receiver’s
power is also set to standby. (Only when the input for
a component connected to the receiver by HDMI
connection is selected or when watching the TV.)
• via HDMI – The TV’s sound is input via the HDMI
terminal. This can only be selected when Control is
set to ON.
• The receiver’s input switches automatically when the
10 Select the ‘12V Trigger’ setting you want.
The component connected to the 12V TRIGGER jack can
be turned on and off when HDMI OUT is switched. HDMI
OUT 1, HDMI OUT 2 or OFF can be selected. Select OFF
when you want the component to switch when the input
function is switched.
Control with HDMI-compatible component is played.
• The receiver’s input switches automatically when the
TV’s channel is switched.
• The synchronized amp mode remains in effect even if
the receiver’s input is switched to a component other
than one connected by HDMI.
11 When you’re finished, press HOME MENU
.
58
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Control with HDMI function
07
The operations below can also be used on Pioneer
Control with HDMI-compatible TVs.
• On players compatible with PQLS Multi Surround,
PQLS works for all sources. Set the player’s audio
output to Linear PCM.
• When the receiver’s volume is adjusted or the sound
is muted, the volume status is displayed on the TV’s
screen.
• On players compatible with PQLS 2 ch Audio, PQLS
only works when playing CDs.
• When the OSD language is switched on the TV, the
receiver’s language setting also switches
accordingly.
Please refer to the operating instructions supplied with
your player for more information.
1
This function is activated when Control is set to ON.
About connections with a product of a
different brand that supports the Control
with HDMI function
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then press
PQLS to select the PQLS setting.
The setting is displayed on the front panel display.
•
Press
The synchronized operations below can be used when
the receiver’s Control with HDMI function is connected
to a TV of a brand other than Pioneer that supports the
Control with HDMI function. (Depending on the TV,
however, some of the Control with HDMI functions may
not work.)
• PQLS AUTO – PQLS is enabled. A precision quartz
controller in this receiver eliminates distortion
caused by timing errors (jitter), giving you the best
possible digital-to-analog conversion when you use
the HDMI interface. This is valid as an HDMI function
for PQLS-compatible players.
• When the TV’s power is set to standby, the receiver’s
power is also set to standby. (Only when the input for
a component connected to the receiver by HDMI
connection is selected or when watching the TV)
• PQLS OFF – PQLS is disabled.
Cautions on the Control with HDMI
function
• The sound of TV programs or an external input
connected to the TV can also be output from the
speakers connected to the receiver. (If the TV does
not support the HDMI Audio Return Channel
function, this requires connection of an optical
digital cable, etc., in addition to the HDMI cable.)
• Connect the TV directly to this receiver. Interrupting a
direct connection with other amps or an AV converter
(such as an HDMI switch) can cause operational
errors.
• Only connect components (Blu-ray disc player, etc.)
you intend to use as a source to the HDMI input of
this receiver. Interrupting a direct connection with
other amps or an AV converter (such as an HDMI
switch) can cause operational errors.
The synchronized operations below can be used when
the receiver’s Control with HDMI function is connected
to a player or recorder of a brand other than Pioneer that
supports the Control with HDMI function.
• When playback starts on the player or recorder, the
receiver’s input switches to the HDMI input to which
that component is connected.
• When Control is set to ON, HDMI Input in The Input
Setup menu on page 40 is automatically set to OFF.
• When the receiver’s Control is turned ON, even if the
receiver’s power is in the standby mode, it is possible
to output the audio and video signals from a player
via HDMI to the TV without producing sound from the
receiver, but only when a Control with HDMI-
compatible component (Blu-ray disc player, etc.) and
compatible TV are connected. In this case, the
receiver’s power turns on and the power and HDMI
indicators light.
See the Pioneer website for the latest information on the
models of non-Pioneer brands and products that support
the Control with HDMI function.
Setting the PQLS function
PQLS (Precision Quartz Lock System) is a digital audio
signal transfer control technology using the Control with
HDMI function. It offers higher-quality audio playback by
controlling audio signals from the receiver to a PQLS
compatible player, etc. This enables removing jitter that
has a negative effect on the quality of the sound and is
generated upon transmission.
Note
1 • If a listening mode other than AUTO SURROUND, ALC, DIRECT, PURE DIRECT or STEREO is selected while the PQLS effect is enabled, the
PQLS effect is disabled.
• When this receiver is connected by HDMI cable to a Pioneer player that is compatible with the PQLS function via HDMI connection and
HDMI reauthentication is performed (the HDMI indicator blinks), the PQLS effect is enabled and the listening mode is set to AUTO
SURROUND if a listening mode other than AUTO SURROUND, ALC, DIRECT, PURE DIRECT or STEREO is selected.
59
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using other functions
08
Chapter 8:
Using other functions
Setting
What it does
Option(s)
BYPASS
ON
Setting the Audio options
TONE
(Tone
Control)
Applies the treble and bass tone
controls to a source, or bypasses
them completely.
There are a number of additional sound settings you can
make using the AUDIO PARAMETER menu. The
defaults, if not stated, are listed in bold.
a
Adjusts the amount of bass.
–6 to +6 (dB)
Default: 0 (dB)
–6 to +6 (dB)
Default: 0 (dB)
BASS
a
Adjusts the amount of treble.
TREBLE
Important
• Note that if a setting doesn’t appear in the AUDIO
PARAMETER menu, it is unavailable due to the
current source, settings and status of the receiver.
b
S.RTRV
(Sound
With the Sound Retriever
function, DSP processing is used
OFF
ON
Retriever) to compensate for the loss of
audio data upon compression,
improving the sound’s sense of
density and modulation.
RECEIVER
AUDIO PARAMETER
1
Press
on the remote control, then press
.
2
Use / to select the setting you want to adjust.
DNR
(Digital
Noise
May improve the quality of sound
in a noisy source (for example,
video tape with lots of background
OFF
Depending on the current status/mode of the receiver,
certain options may not be able to be selected. Check the
table below for notes on this.
ON
Reduction) noise) when switched on.
DIALOG E Localizes dialog in the center
OFF
FLAT
3
Use / to set as necessary.
(Dialog
Enhance
ment)
channel to make it stand out from
other background sounds in a TV
or movie soundtrack. By moving
from UP1 through UP2 and UP3
up to UP4, you can make the
sound source seem to relocate
upwards.
See the table below for the options available for each
setting.
UP1/UP2/UP3/
c
UP4
4
Press RETURN to confirm and exit the menu.
Setting
What it does
Option(s)
MCACC
(MCACC
preset)
Selects your favorite MCACC
preset memory when multiple
preset memoriesare saved. When M6. MEMORY 6
an MCACC preset memory has
been renamed, the given name is
displayed.
M1. MEMORY 1
Creates a wider dynamic range with
digital sources like CDs or DVDs.
Smoother, more delicate musical
expression can be achieved by
requantizing 16 bit PCM or 20 bit
compressed audio signals to 24 bit.
to
Hi-bit
(High Bit/
High
OFF
ON
Default:
M1. MEMORY 1
Sampling)
EQ
Switches on/off the effects of EQ
Pro.
ON
DUAL
(Dual
Mono)
Specifies how dual mono
encoded Dolby Digital
soundtracks should be played.
Dual mono is not widely used, but
is sometimes necessary when
two languages need to be sent to
separate channels.
CH1–Channel
1 is heard only
(Acoustic
Calibration
EQ)
OFF
CH2–Channel
2 is heard only
S-WAVE
Switches on/off the effects of
ON
(Standing Standing Wave Control.
Wave)
CH1 CH2 –
Both channels
heard from
OFF
DELAY
(Sound
Delay)
Some monitors have a slight
delay when showing video, so the
soundtrack will be slightly out of
sync with the picture. By adding a
bit of delay, you can adjust the
sound to match the presentation
of the video.
0.0 to 10.0
(frames)
front speakers
d
DRC
Adjusts the level of dynamic
1 second = 30
frames (NTSC)
AUTO
(Dynamic range for movie soundtracks
MAX
MID
OFF
Range
Control)
optimized for Dolby Digital, DTS,
Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby TrueHD,
DTS-HD and DTS-HD Master
Audio (you may need to use this
feature when listening to
Default: 0.0
MIDNIGHT Allows you to hear effective
surround sound of movies at low
volumes.
MIDNIGHT/
LOUDNESS
OFF
surround sound at low volumes).
MIDNIGHT ON
LOUDNESS Used to get good bass and treble
from music sources at low
volumes.
LOUDNESS
ON
60
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using other functions
08
Setting
What it does
Option(s)
Setting
EFFECT
What it does
Option(s)
LFE
(LFE
Some audio sources include
ultra-low bass tones. Set the LFE –10dB/ –15dB/
0dB/ –5dB/
Sets the effect level for the
currently selected Advanced
Surround or ALC mode (each
mode can be set separately).
10 to 90
Defaults:
EXT.STEREO:
90
Attenuate) attenuator as necessary to
prevent the ultra-low bass tones
from distorting the sound from
the speakers.
–20dB
OFF
Others: 50
H.GAIN
(Height
Gain)
Adjusts the output from the front
height speaker when listening in
DOLBY PLIIz HEIGHT mode. If set
to HIGH, the sound from the top
will be more emphasized.
LOW
MID
The LFE is not limited when set to
0 dB, which is the recommended
value. When set to –5 dB, –10 dB,
–15 dB or –20 dB, the LFE is
limited by the respective degree.
When OFF is selected, no sound
is output from the LFE channel.
HIGH
V.SB
When you’re not using surround
back speakers, selecting this
mode allows you to hear a virtual
surround back channel through
your surround speakers. You can
choose to listen to sources with
no surround back channel
information, or if the material
sounds better in the format (for
example, 5.1) for which it was
originally encoded, you can have
the receiver only apply this effect
to 6.1 encoded sources like Dolby
OFF
(Virtual
Surround
Back)
ON
SACD
Brings out detail in SACDs by
maximizing the dynamic range
(during digital processing).
0dB
e
GAIN
+6 dB
f
Specifies the routing of the HDMI
audio signal out of this receiver
(amp) or through to a TV. When
THROUGH is selected, no sound
is output from this receiver.
AMP
HDMI
(HDMI
Audio)
THROUGH
A. DELAY This feature automatically
(Auto
delay)
OFF
corrects the audio-to-video delay
between components connected
with an HDMI cable. The audio
delay time is set depending on the
operational status of the display
connected with an HDMI cable.
The video delay time is
ON
j
Digital EX or DTS-ES.
V.HEIGHT When you’re not using front
(Virtual
Height)
OFF
height speakers, selecting this
mode allows you to hear a virtual
front height channel through your
ON
k
front speakers.
automatically adjusted according
a.The adjustment can be made only when TONE is set to ON.
b.With the iPod/USB, INTERNET RADIO or ADAPTER PORT input
function, by default S.RTRV is set to ON.
c.UP1 to UP4 can be selected only when the front height speaker is
connected. The presence or absence of effects depends on the
listening mode.
d.The initially set AUTO is only available for Dolby TrueHD signals.
Select MAX or MID for signals other than Dolby TrueHD.
e.You shouldn’t have any problems using this with most SACD
discs, but if the sound distorts, it is best to switch the gain setting
back to 0 dB.
f. • The HDMI Audio setting cannot be switched while performing
synchronized amp mode operations.
g
to the audio delay time.
h
Provides a better blend of the
front speakers by spreading the
center channel between the front
right and left speakers, making it
sound wider (higher settings) or
narrower (lower settings).
0 to 7
C. WIDTH
(Center
Width)
(Applicable
only when
using a
Default: 3
center
speaker)
h
Adjusts the depth of the surround
sound balance from front to back,
making the sound more distant
(minus settings), or more forward
(positive settings).
–3 to +3
DIMENSION
Default: 0
• The synchronized amp mode must be turned on in order to play
the receiver’s HDMI audio and video input signals from the TV with
the receiver’s power in the standby mode. See About synchronized
operations on page 58.
g.This feature is only available when the connected display supports
the automatic audio/video synchronizing capability (‘lipsync’) for
HDMI. If you find the automatically set delay time unsuitable, set A.
DELAY to OFF and adjust the delay time manually. For more details
about the lipsync feature of your display, contact the manufacturer
directly.
h.Only when listening to 2-channel sources in Dolby Pro Logic IIx
Music/Dolby Pro Logic II Music mode.
i. Only when listening to 2-channel sources in Neo:6 MUSIC/CINEMA
mode.
h
Extends the front stereo image to
include the surround speakers for
a ‘wraparound’ effect.
OFF
PANORAMA
ON
i
Adjusts the center image to
create a wider stereo effect with
vocals. Adjust the effect from 0
(all center channel sent to front
right and left speakers) to 10
(center channel sent to the center
speaker only).
0 to 10
C. IMAGE
(Center
Image)
Defaults:
Neo:6 MUSIC:
3
Neo:6
CINEMA: 10
(Applicable
only when
using a
center
speaker)
61
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using other functions
08
j. • You can’t use the Virtual Surround Back mode when the
headphones are connected to this receiver or when any of the
stereo, Front Stage Surround Advance, Sound Retriever Air or
Stream Direct modes is selected.
• You can only use the Virtual Surround Back mode if the surround
speakers are on and the SB setting is set to NO or if Front Bi-Amp
or ZONE 2 is selected at Speaker System. It can also be used when
Speaker B is selected at Speaker system and SPAB is selected
with the SPEAKERS button.
• When inputting Dolby True HD, DTS-HD or DTS Express audio
signals, the Virtual Surround Back mode cannot be used if no
surround signals are recorded in the source.
k.• You can’t use the Virtual Height mode when the headphones are
connected to this receiver or when any of the stereo, Front Stage
Surround Advance, Sound Retriever Air or Stream Direct modes is
selected.
Setting
What it does
Option(s)
AUTO
b
Specifies the output resolution of
the video signal (when video input
signals are output at the HDMI
OUT connector, select this
according to the resolution of your
monitor and the images you wish
to watch).
RES
(Resolution)
PURE
480p/576p
720p
1080i
1080p
1080/24p
THROUGH
NORMAL
c
Specifies the aspect ratio when
input signals are output at the
HDMI output. Make your desired
settings while checking each
setting on your display (if the
image doesn’t match your monitor
type, cropping or black bands
appear).
ASP
(Aspect)
• The Virtual Height mode cannot be used when no surround
speaker is connected. It can also not be used when playing signals
containing actual front height channel information.
• When inputting certain Dolby TrueHD, DTS-HD or DTS Express
audio signals, the Virtual Height mode cannot be used if no
surround signals are recorded in the source.
d,e
This setting optimizes the
AUTO
ON
PCINEMA
(PureCinema)
operation of the progressive
scanning circuit for playing film
materials. Normally set it to AUTO.
If the picture seems unnatural,
switch this to ON or OFF.
OFF
Setting the Video options
There are a number of additional picture settings you can
make using the VIDEO PARAMETERmenu. The defaults,
if not stated, are listed in bold.
d,e
Adjusts the motion and still picture
quality when video output is set to
progressive.
–4 to +4
P.MOTION
(Progressive
Motion)
Default: 0
Important
d
Reduces noise in the luminance
(Y) signal.
0 to +8
Default: 0
0 to +8
YNR
• Note that if an option cannot be selected on the
VIDEO PARAMETER menu, it is unavailable due to
the current source, setting and status of the receiver.
d
Reduces noise in the input’s color
(C) signal.
CNR
Default: 0
0 to +8
• All of the setting items can be set for each input
function.
d
Reduces block noise (block-
shaped distortion generated upon
MPEG compression) in the
picture.
BNR
Default: 0
• Setting items other than V. CONV can only be
selected when V. CONV is set to ON.
d
Reduces mosquito noise
(distortion generated at the
contours of the picture upon
MPEG compression) in the
picture.
0 to +8
RECEIVER
VIDEO PARAMETER
MNR
1
Press
on the remote control, then press
.
Default: 0
2
Use / to select the setting you want to adjust.
Depending on the current status/mode of the receiver,
certain options may not be able to be selected. Check the
table below for notes on this.
d
Adjusts how sharp edges appear.
0 to +8
Default: 0
–6 to +6
Default: 0
–6 to +6
Default: 0
–6 to +6
Default: 0
–6 to +6
Default: 0
DETAIL
d
Adjusts the overall brightness.
BRIGHT
(Brightness)
3
Use / to set as necessary.
See the table below for the options available for each
d
setting.
Adjusts the contrast between light
and dark.
CONTRAST
4
Press RETURN to confirm and exit the menu.
d
Adjusts the red/green balance.
HUE
Setting
What it does
Option(s)
a
Converts video signals for output
from the MONITOR OUT jacks
(including HDMI OUT connector)
for all video types (see page 22).
ON
V. CONV
d
Adjusts saturation from dull to
bright.
CHROMA
(Chroma
Level)
(DigitalVideo
Conversion)
OFF
f
Corrects the black depth in the
brightness signal.
7.5
BLK SETUP
0
Normally select 7.5. If the dark
parts of the picture are all black
with this setting, select 0.
62
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using other functions
08
a.If the video picture deteriorates when this settings is switched ON,
switch it OFF.
b.• When set to a resolution with which the TV (monitor) is not
compatible, no picture is output. Also, in some cases no picture will
be output due to copyright protection signals. In this case, change
the setting.
• When AUTO is selected, the resolution is selected automatically
according to the capacity of the TV (monitor) connected by HDMI.
When PURE is selected, the signals are output with the same
resolution as when input (see About the video converter on page 22).
• If this is set to something other than AUTO, PURE and 480i/576i
analog signals are input, 480p/576p signals are output from the
component output terminals.
Switching the speaker terminals
If you selected Speaker B at Speaker system setting on
page 85, you can switch between speakers using the
SPEAKERS button. If you selected Normal(SB/FH),
Normal(SB/FW), Front Bi-Amp or ZONE 2, the button
will simply switch your main speaker terminals on or off.
1
The options below are for the Speaker B setting only.
•
Use SPEAKERS on the front panel to select a
speaker system setting.
• When 1080/24p is selected, depending on the source material the
movement may be unnatural or the picture may not be clear. In this
case, set the resolution to something other than 1080/24p.
• 1080/24p is mainly effective for movie source materials.
c.• If the image doesn’t match your monitor type, adjust the aspect
ratio on the source component or on the monitor.
• This setting is only displayed when 480i/p or 576i/p video signals
are being input.
d.This setting is only displayed when the video signals below are
being input:
• 480i, 576i, 480p, 576p, 720p, 1080i analog video signals
• 480i, 576i, 480p, 576p, 720p, 1080i, 1080p, 1080p24 HDMI video
signals
As mentioned above, if you have selected Normal(SB/
FH) or Normal(SB/FW), the button will simply switch
your main speaker terminal (A) on or off.
Press repeatedly to choose a speaker terminal option:
• SPA – Sound is output from the A-speaker
terminals (up to 7 channels (including surround back
channels), depending on the source).
• SPB – Sound is output from the two speakers
connected to the B-speaker terminals. Multichannel
sources will not be heard.
e.• This setting is valid for component outputs and HDMI output.
• This setting have the effect only for pictures recorded in the
interlaced scan format (480i/576i or 1080i signals).
• P.MOTION is disabled when PCINEMA is set to ON.
f. You can’t use this setting when the HDMI or component video
signals are being input.
• SPAB – Sound is output from the A-speaker
terminals (up to 5 channels, depending on the
source), the two speakers connected to the B-
speaker terminals, and the subwoofer. The sound
from the B-speaker terminals will be the same as the
sound from the A-speaker terminals (multichannel
sources will be downmixed to 2 channels).
• SP (off) – No sound is output from the speakers.
Using the MULTI-ZONE controls
The following steps use the front panel controls to adjust
the sub zone volume and select sources. See MULTI-
ZONE remote controls on page 64.
1
Press MULTI-ZONE ON/OFF on the front panel.
Each press selects a MULTI-ZONE option:
• ZONE 2 ON – Selects your primary (ZONE 2) sub
zone
• ZONE 2&3 ON – Select both sub zones
• ZONE 3 ON – Selects your secondary (ZONE 3) sub
zone
• MULTI ZONE OFF – Switches the MULTI-ZONE
feature off
The MULTI-ZONE indicator lights when the MULTI-ZONE
control has been switched ON.
2
Press MULTI-ZONE CONTROL on the front panel to
select the sub zone(s) you want.
If you selected ZONE 2&3 ON above, you can toggle
between ZONE 2 and ZONE 3.
Note
1 • The subwoofer output depends on the settings you made in Manual speaker setup on page 84. However, if SPB is selected above, no sound
is heard from the subwoofer (the LFE channel is not downmixed).
• All speaker systems (except Speaker B connections) are switched off when headphones are connected.
63
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using other functions
08
1
• When the receiver is on, make sure that any
operations for the sub zone are done while ZONE and
your selected sub zone(s) show in the display. If this
is not showing, the front panel controls affect the
main zone only.
Making an audio or a video recording
You can make an audio or a video recording from the
built-in tuner, or from an audio or video source
4
connected to the receiver (such as a CD player or TV).
3
Use the INPUT SELECTOR dial to select the source
Keep in mind you can’t make a digital recording from an
analog source or vice-versa, so make sure the
components you are recording to/from are hooked up in
the same way (see Connecting your equipment on
page 16 for more on connections).
for the zone you have selected.
For example, ZONE 2 CD-R sends the source connected
to the CD-R inputs to the primary (ZONE 2) sub room.
• If you select TUNER, you can use the tuner controls
to select a preset station (see Saving station presets
on page 46 if you’re unsure how to do this).
Since the video converter is not available when making
recordings (from the video OUT jacks) make sure to use
the same type of video cable for connecting your recorder
as you used to connect your video source (the one you
want to record) to this receiver. For example, you must
connect your recorder using Component video if your
source has also been connected using Component video.
2
4
When Speaker System is set to ZONE 2, use the
MASTER VOLUME dial to adjust the volume for the sub
zone.
5
When you’re finished, press MULTI-ZONE
CONTROL again to return to the main zone controls.
1
Select the source you want to record.
You can also press MULTI-ZONE ON/OFF on the front
3
Use the input function buttons (or INPUT SELECT).
panel to switch off all output to the sub zone(s).
2
Prepare the source you want to record.
MULTI-ZONE remote controls
Tune to the radio station, load the CD, video, DVD etc.
Set the MULTI-ZONE operation switch to ZONE 2 or ZONE
3 to operate the corresponding zone.
3
Select the input signal according to the signal to be
recorded.
The following table shows the possible MULTI-ZONE
remote controls:
Use the remote control’s SIGNAL SEL button.
4
Prepare the recorder.
Button
What it does
Insert a blank tape, MD, video etc. into the recording
device and set the recording levels. Refer to the
instructions that came with the recorder if you are
unsure how to do this. Most video recorders set the audio
recording level automatically—check the component’s
instruction manual if you’re unsure.
Switches on/off power in the sub zone.
INPUT SELECT Use to select the input function in the sub
zone.
Input function Use to select the input function directly (this
buttons
may not work for some functions) in the sub
zone.
5
Start recording, then start playback of the source
MASTER
VOLUME +/–
Use to set the listening volume in the sub
component.
a
zone.
MUTE
Mutes the sound or restores the sound if it has
been muted (adjusting the volume also
restores the sound).a
Reducing the level of an analog signal
The input attenuator lowers the input level of an analog
signal when it’s too strong. You can use this if you find
that the OVER indicator lights often or you can hear
a.You can only use this button when Speaker System is set to ZONE 2
.
5
distortion in the sound.
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then press
•
Press
A.ATT to switch the input attenuator on or off.
Note
1 If the receiver is in standby, the display is dimmed, and ZONE and your selected sub zone(s) continue to show in the display.
2 The tuner cannot be tuned to more than one station at a time. Therefore, changing the station in one zone also changes the station in the other
zone. Please be careful not to change stations when recording a radio broadcast.
3 • You won’t be able to switch the main zone off completely unless you’ve switched off the MULTI-ZONE control first.
• If you don’t plan to use the MULTI-ZONE feature for a while, turn off the power in both the sub and main rooms so that this receiver is in
standby.
4 • The receiver’s volume, Audio parameters (the tone controls, for example), and surround effects have no effect on the recorded signal.
• Some digital sources are copy-protected, and can only be recorded in analog.
• Some video sources are copy-protected. These cannot be recorded.
5 The attenuator isn’t available with digital sources, or when using the Stream Direct (ANALOG DIRECT) modes.
64
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using other functions
Using the sleep timer
08
Using the Web Control function
The sleep timer switches the receiver into standby after a
specified amount of time so you can fall asleep without
worrying about the receiver being left on all night. Use
the remote control to set the sleep timer.
The receiver can be operated using a browser from a
computer connected on the same LAN as the receiver.
1
Turn on the computer and launch the Internet
browser.
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then press
SLEEP repeatedly to set the sleep time.
•
Press
2
In the address bar on the browser, enter the IP
address assigned to this receiver.
For example, if the IP address of this receiver is
“192.168.0.2”, enter “http://192.168.0.2/”.
30 min
Off
60 min
90 min
When the connection is made with the receiver, a Top
Menu will be displayed.
• You can check the remaining sleep time at any time
This receiver’s IP address can be found in the ‘IP address,
Proxy’ menu (page 87).
by pressing SLEEP once. Pressing repeatedly will
1
cycle through the sleep options again.
3
Once the Top Menu is displayed, click the button for
the zone you want to operate.
Dimming the display
4
Operate from the screen for the individual zone.
• Even when the receiver is in the standby mode, it can
be turned on using the Web Control function. For
details, see Network Standby on page 88.
You can choose between four brightness levels for the
front panel display. Note that when selecting sources, the
display automatically brightens for a few seconds.
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then press
•
Press
Top Menu
DIMMER repeatedly to change the brightness of the
front panel display.
Web Control
Main ZONE
ZONE 2
ZONE 3
POWER
ON
OFF
VOLUME
-60.0dB
MUTE
INPUT SELECT
DVD
Switching the HDMI output
LISTENING MODE STEREO
AUTO SURR/ALC/
STREAM DIRECT
HOME
THX
STANDARD
SURROUND
ADVANCED
SURROUND
Set which terminal to use when outputting video and
STEREO
audio signals from the HDMI output terminals.
The HDMI OUT1 terminal is compatible with the Control
with HDMI function.
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then press
.
•
Press
HDMI OUT
Please wait a while when Please wait ... is displayed.
The output switches among HDMI OUT ALL HDMI OUT
Checking your system settings
Use the status display screen to check your current
settings for features such as surround back channel
processing and your current MCACC preset.
,
2
1 and HDMI OUT 2 each time the button is pressed.
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then press
1
Press
STATUS to check the system settings.
The front panel display shows each of the following
settings for three seconds each: Input function,
Sampling Frequency, MCACC preset, ZONE 2 input,
ZONE 3 input and HDMI OUT.
2
When you’re finished, press STATUS again to
switch off the display.
Note
1 The sleep timer is valid for all zones. If any zone is on, the sleep timer continues functioning.
2 • The synchronized amp mode is canceled when the HDMI output is switched. If you wish to use the synchronized amp mode, switch to HDMI
OUT 1, then select the synchronized amp mode on the TV using the TV’s remote control.
• When the power is turned off then back on after switching the HDMI output, the input is set to a setting between HDMI 1 and HDMI 4, or BD.
65
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using other functions
Resetting the system
08
Setting
Default
DSP
Power On Level
Volume Limit
Mute Level
Phase Control
Sound Retriever
LAST
OFF
FULL
ON
Use this procedure to reset all the receiver’s settings to
the factory default. Use the front panel controls to do this.
Set MULTI-ZONE to OFF.
• Disconnect the iPod and USB memory device from
the receiver beforehand.
iPod/USB, INTERNET
RADIO, ADAPTER
PORT function
ON
1
2
Switch the receiver into standby.
Other functions
OFF
While holding down ENTER on the front panel,
press STANDBY/ON
The display shows RESET NO .
.
Sound Delay
Dual Mono
DRC
0.0 frame
CH1
AUTO
3
Select ‘RESET’ using PRESET /, then press
SACD Gain
LFE Attenuate
Auto delay
Digital Safety
Effect Level
0 dB
ENTER on the front panel.
The display shows RESET? OK.
0 dB
OFF
4
Press ENTER to confirm.
OFF
OK appears in the display to indicate that the receiver
has been reset to the factory default settings.
ExtendedStereo
Other modes
Center Width
Dimension
90
50
• Note that all settings will be saved, even if the
receiver is unplugged.
2 PL II Music
Options
3
0
Default system settings
Panorama
OFF
Neo:6 Options
Center Image
Neo:6 MUSIC: 3
Neo:6 CINEMA: 10
Setting
Default
ON
Digital Video Conversion
SPEAKERS
All Inputs
Listening Mode
(2 ch/multi ch)
AUTO
SURROUND
A
Speaker System
Normal (SB/FH)
SMALL
SMALL
SMALL
SMALL
SMALLx2
YES
Listening Mode (HP) STEREO
Speaker Setting
Front
See also Setting the Audio options on page 60 for other default
DSP settings.
Center
FH/FW
Surr
MCACC
MCACC Position Memory
Channel Level (M1 to M6)
Speaker Distance (M1 to M6)
M1: MEMORY 1
0.0 dB
SB
SW
10.00 ft
Surround Position
Crossover
IN REAR
80 Hz
Standing Wave
(M1 to M6)
ATT of all channels/ 0.0 dB
filters
X-Curve
OFF
SWch Wide Trim
0.0 dB
THX Audio Setting
DIMMER
4 ft<
EQ Data (M1 to M6)
All channels/bands 0.0 dB
EQ Wide Trim 0.0 dB
Brightest
OFF
Network Standby
Inputs
See Input function default and possible settings on page 41.
HDMI
HDMI Audio
HDMI output
Control
Amp
HDMI OUT ALL
ON
ALL
YES
Control Mode
DIsplay Power Off
66
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controlling the rest of your system
09
Chapter 9:
Controlling the rest of your system
Setting
What it does
About the Remote Setup menu
Change RC If you have multiple Pioneer receivers, amplifiers,
mode
etc., this setting can be used to prevent other units
from operating simultaneously when the remote
control unit is operated. See “Operating multiple
receivers” on page 67.
The Remote Setup mode is set by pressing the number
button while pressing R.SETUP. The different items on
the Remote Setup menu are described below. For their
setting procedures, refer to the explanations for the
respective items.
Note
Setting
What it does
• You can cancel or exit any of the steps by pressing
R.SETUP.
Preset
recall
Preset codes can be set for the various input
functions. The remote control codes of a number
of other devices (including products of other
brands) are preset in the remote control to allow
these devices to be operated. See “Selecting
preset codes directly” on page 68.
• After one minute of inactivity, the remote
automatically exits the operation.
Code
learning
If the desired operations cannot be performed
even though you have set the preset codes, the
remote control signals of other devices can be
learned directly. See “Programming signals from
other remote controls” on page 68.
Operating multiple receivers
Up to four receivers can be operated discretely using this
receiver's remote control when using multiple receivers,
provided they are of the same model as this receiver. The
receiver to be operated is switched by inputting the
preset code to set the remote control setting.
Multi
A series of the remote control operations for
operation starting listening or viewing can be programmed.
Multiple remote control codes can be set for the
different input functions. See “Multi operation and
System off” on page 70.
• Set the remote modes on the receivers before using
this function (see Remote Control Mode Setup on
page 89).
System off This is a function for automatically turning off the
power of devices connected to the receiver.
Multiple remote control codes can be set, as
desired. See “Multi operation and System off” on
page 70.
1
Press and hold R.SETUP, then press “4” for three
seconds.
The LED flashes continuously.
• To cancel the preset setup mode press R.SETUP.
Direct
function
This is a setting for changing only the remote
control unit’s operation screen, without changing
the receiver’s input, when the remote control
unit’s input function buttons are pressed. This is
convenient for using the remote control unit for
devices not connected to the receiver. See “Direct
function” on page 69.
2
1
Press the number button for the receiver (“Receiver
” to “Receiver 4”) you wish to operate.
For example, to operate “Receiver 2”, press “2”.
If the LED lights for one second, the setting has been
successfully completed.
When the preset code is input, the LED flashes three
times to indicate that the setting has failed.
Erase
learning
This function is used to erase remote control
codes that have been learned. Codes learned for
the different input functions can be erased
individually. See “Erasing one of the remote
control button settings” on page 69.
Back light The backlight lighting pattern can be selected
from among four modes, in consideration of
convenience and battery service life. See “Setting
the backlight mode” on page 70.
Reset
function
This is a function for resetting preset codes that
have been set. Key resetting can be done for
individual input functions. See “Erasing all learnt
settings that are in one input function” on page 69.
All reset
This is a function for resetting all remote control
unit settings you have made to the defaults set
upon shipment from the factory. See “Resetting
the remote control settings” on page 72.
67
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controlling the rest of your system
09
If the LED lights for one second, the setting has been
successfully completed.
Setting the remote to control other
components
When the preset code is fully input, the LED flashes three
times to indicate that the setting has failed. If this
happens, enter the 4-digit preset code again.
Most components can be assigned to one of the input
function buttons (such as DVD or CD) using the
component’s manufacturer preset code stored in the
remote.
4
Repeat steps 2 through 3 for the other components
you want to control.
To try out the remote control, switch the component on or
off (into standby) by pressing SOURCE. If it doesn’t
seem to work, select the next code from the list (if there
is one).
However, there are cases where only certain functions
may be controllable after assigning the proper preset
code, or the codes for the manufacturer in the remote
control will not work for the model that you are using.
5
Press R.SETUP to exit the preset setup mode.
If you can’t find a preset code that matches the
component you want to control, you can still teach the
remote individual commands from another remote
control (see Programming signals from other remote
controls on page 68).
Programming signals from other
remote controls
• For greater convenience, assign the TV connected to
the MONITOR OUT terminal to the TV CTRL button,
and assign your satellite/cable receiver or set-top box
connected to the TV input terminal to the TV input
button. If a single device is connected to both
terminals, that device should be assigned to both the
TV CTRL and TV input buttons.
If the preset code for your component is not available, or
the available preset codes do not operate correctly, you
can program signals from the remote control of another
component. This can also be used to program additional
operations (buttons not covered in the presets) after
1
assigning a preset code.
Certain buttons represent operations that cannot be
learned from other remote controls. The buttons
available are shown below:
• Devices may be assigned to the following input
function buttons.
AUDIO
VIDEO
MULTI
RECEIVER
SOURCE
PARAMETER
PARAMETER
OPERATION
LIST TUNE TOOLS
R.SETUP
TOP MENU
BAND
T.EDIT
GUIDE
BD
TV
DVD DVR/BDR HDMI
PRESET
ENTER
TUNE
PRESET
CD NET RADIO ADAPTER
MULTI
RECEIVER
SOURCE
OPERATION
CATEGORY
RETURN
iPod USB TUNER SIRIUS
INPUT SELECT TV CTRL
XM
R.SETUP
HOME
MENU
iPod CTRL
BD
TV
DVD DVR/BDR HDMI
RECEIVER
AUTO /ALC
/
PGM MEMORY MENU
DIRECT STEREO STANDARD ADV SURR
CD NET RADIO ADAPTER
HDD
THX
DVD
PHASE CTRL
STATUS
AUDIO
iPod USB TUNER SIRIUS
INPUT SELECT TV CTRL
XM
TV
/
DTV
MPX
PQLS
RECEIVER
Selecting preset codes directly
HDMI OUT
2
1
3
MASTER
VOLUME
INPUT
SIGNAL SEL MCACC SLEEP
INFO
DISP
1
Press and hold R.SETUP, then press “1” for three
4
5
6
TV CONTROL
seconds.
CH LEVEL A.ATT DIMMER
7
8
9
The LED flashes continuously.
CH
VOL
MUTE
CH
D.ACCESS
CLASS
ENTER
/
CLR
0
• To cancel the preset setup mode press R.SETUP.
2
Press the input function button for the component
1
Press and hold R.SETUP, then press “2” for three
you want to control.
seconds.
When assigning preset codes to TV CONTROL, press TV
The LED flashes continuously.
CTRL here.
• To cancel the preset setup mode press R.SETUP.
The LED blinks once and flashes continuously.
2
Press the input function button for the component
3
Use the number buttons to enter the 4-digit preset
you want to control.
code.
The LED blinks once and flashes continuously.
See Preset code list on page 107.
Note
1 The remote can store about 120 preset codes from other components (this has been tested with codes of Pioneer format only).
68
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controlling the rest of your system
09
3
Point the two remote controls towards each other,
then press the button that will be doing the learning on
this receiver’s remote control.
The LED blinks once and flashes continuously.
Erasing all learnt settings that are in
one input function
This operation erases all the operational settings of other
devices that have been programmed in one input
function, and restores the factory default.
• The remote controls should be 3 cm (1 inch) apart.
This function is handy for erasing all data programmed
for devices no longer being used.
3 cm
(1 inch)
Other remote
control
This receiver’s
remote control
1
Press and hold R.SETUP, then press “9” for three
seconds.
The LED flashes continuously.
4
Press the corresponding button on the other remote
• To cancel the preset setup mode press R.SETUP.
control that is sending (teaching) the signal to this
receiver’s remote control.
If the LED lights for one second, the setting has been
2
Press and hold the input function button
corresponding to the command to be erased for three
seconds.
1
successfully completed.
If the LED lights for one second, the erasing has been
successfully completed.
5
To program additional signals for the current
component repeat steps 3 and 4.
To program signals for another component, exit and
repeat steps 2 through 4.
Direct function
6
Press R.SETUP to exit the programming mode.
• Default setting: On
You can use the direct function feature to control one
component using the remote control while at the same
time using your receiver to play a different component.
This could let you, for example, use the remote control to
set up and listen to a CD on the receiver, and then use the
remote control to rewind a tape in your VCR while you
continue to listen to your CD player.
Erasing one of the remote control
button settings
This erases one of the buttons you have programmed and
restores the button to the factory default.
1
Press and hold R.SETUP, then press “7” for three
When direct function is on, any component you select
(using the input function buttons) will be selected by both
the receiver and the remote control. When you turn direct
function off, you can operate the remote control without
affecting the receiver.
seconds.
The LED flashes continuously.
• To cancel the preset setup mode press R.SETUP.
2
Press the input function button corresponding to
the command to be erased, then press ENTER
The LED flashes once.
.
1
Press and hold R.SETUP, then press “5” for three
seconds.
The LED flashes continuously.
3
Press and hold the button to be erased for three
seconds.
• To cancel the preset setup mode press R.SETUP.
If the LED lights for one second, the erasing has been
successfully completed.
2
Press the input function button for the component
you want to control.
4
5
Repeat step 3 to erase other buttons.
Press R.SETUP to exit the erasing mode.
3
Press “1” (On) or “0” (Off) to switch the direct
function mode.
If the LED lights for one second, the setting has been
successfully completed.
If the LED flashes three times, the setting has failed.
4
Press R.SETUP to exit the setup.
Note
1 • Note that interference from TVs or other devices will sometimes result in the remote control learning the wrong signal.
• Some commands from other remote controls cannot be learned, but in most cases the remotes just need to be moved closer together or
farther apart.
• If the LED flashes for five seconds, it means the memory is full. See Erasing all learnt settings that are in one input function on page 69 to
erase a programmed button you’re not using to free up more memory (note that some signals may take more memory than others).
69
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controlling the rest of your system
09
Setting the backlight mode
Multi operation and System off
• Default setting: 1 (normal mode)
The Multi operation feature allows you to program a
series of up to 5 commands for the components in your
system.
The backlight lighting pattern can be selected from
among four modes, in consideration of convenience and
battery service life.
•
Be sure to call up the preset codes of devices or
perform programming signals for other remote
controls before multi operation memory
programming (page 68).
1
Press and hold R.SETUP, then press “6” for three
seconds.
The LED flashes continuously.
The Multi operation feature makes it easy to perform the
following operations by pressing just two buttons.
• To cancel the preset setup mode press R.SETUP.
2
Press the number button for the backlight mode
Press MULTI OPERATION and then the DVD input
function button to:
you want to set.
•
•
“1” (normal mode) – The backlight is turned on and
off with the light button. After it lights, it turns off
automatically if no operation is performed for 10
seconds.
1. Switch this receiver on.
2. Switch this receiver’s input to DVD.
3. Transmit a sequence of up to five programmed
commands.
“2” (frequent lighting mode – The backlight turns
)
Similar to Multi operations, System off allows you to use
two buttons to stop and switch off a series of components
in your system at the same time. Only one System off
operation sequence may be programmed.
on when any button on the remote control is pressed.
It is turned off with the light button. After it lights, it
turns off automatically if no operation is performed
for 10 seconds.
1
Press MULTI OPERATION and then SOURCE to:
•
•
“3” (eco mode) – The backlight is turned on and off
with the light button. After it lights, it turns off
automatically if no operation is performed for 5
seconds.
1. Transmit a sequence of up to five programmed
commands.
2. Switch off all Pioneer devices including the receiver
(except DVD recorders and VCRs).
“4” (off mode) – The backlight does not turn on even
when the light button is pressed.
For greater convenience, program this receiver to
perform power on/off and playback operations on non-
If the LED lights for one second, the setting has been
successfully completed.
2
Pioneer devices as well. (The signals for Pioneer devices
described above are not contingent on programming for
non-Pioneer devices.)
If the LED flashes three, the setting has failed.
The buttons that can be programmed using Multi
operation or System off are the same buttons as those
that can be programmed for other remote controls (see
Programming signals from other remote controls on
page 68).
3
Press R.SETUP to exit the setup.
Note
1 • Before Multi operation and System off will work correctly, you must setup the remote to work with your TV and other components (see Setting
the remote to control other components on page 68 for more on this).
• Some units may take some time to power up, in which case multiple operations may not be possible.
• Power on and off commands only work with components that have a standby mode.
2 Some remote controllers for other manufacturers' devices use the same signals for switching the power on and off. In some cases, even if this
receiver is programmed to perform these commands, power to the non-Pioneer devices may not be switched on and off correctly. Program
the receiver to perform these commands if the non-Pioneer device uses separate signals for power on/off.
70
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controlling the rest of your system
09
Programming a Multi operation or a
shutdown sequence
Using System off
Press MULTI OPERATION
1
.
The LED flashes continuously.
1
Press and hold R.SETUP, then press “3” for three
seconds.
The LED flashes continuously.
2
Within five seconds, press SOURCE
.
The command sequence you programmed will run, then
all Pioneer components will switch off , followed by this
2
• To cancel the preset setup mode press R.SETUP.
receiver (switch of all the zones becomes off).
2
Press the input function button (or SOURCE
button).
Erasing the settings for the multi-operation
This erases all the settings programmed in the remote
control for the multi-operation.
For Multi operations, press the input function you wish to
program (for example, if you want to start the sequence
1
by switching on your DVD player, press DVD).
1
Press and hold R.SETUP, then press “8” for three
For System off, press the SOURCE button.
seconds.
The LED flashes continuously.
The LED blinks twice and flashes continuously.
• To cancel the preset setup mode press R.SETUP.
3
If necessary, press the input function button for the
component whose command you want to input.
This is only necessary if the command is for a new
component (input function).
2
Press the input function button containing the
program you want to cancel or the SOURCE button
for three seconds.
If the LED lights for one second, the erasing has been
successfully completed.
4
Select the button for the command you want to
input.
The LED blinks once and flashes continuously.
• You don’t need to program the receiver to switch on
or off. This is done automatically.
With Pioneer components, you don’t need to program
the power to switch off in a shutdown sequence (except
DVD recorders).
5
Repeat steps 3 to 4 to program a sequence of up to
five commands.
If you press R.SETUP before programming is completed,
commands programmed up to that point will be stored.
6
Press R.SETUP to exit the programming mode.
Using multi operations
Press MULTI OPERATION
1
.
The LED flashes continuously.
2
Within five seconds, press an input function
button that has been set up with a multi operation.
The receiver switches on (if it was in standby) and the
programmed multi operation is performed automatically.
Note
1 With Multi operation, the HDMI and TV CTRL settings cannot be made. For other settable input functions, see Setting the remote to control
other components on page 68.
2 In order to avoid accidently switching off a DVD recorder that is currently recording, no DVD recorder power off codes are sent.
71
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controlling the rest of your system
09
Resetting the remote control settings
Controlling components
Use this procedure to reset all the remote control’s
This remote control can control components after
entering the proper codes (see Setting the remote to
control other components on page 68 for more on this).
Use the input function buttons to select the component.
1
settings to the factory default.
1
Press and hold R.SETUP, then press “0” for three
seconds.
The LED flashes continuously.
• The TV CONTROL buttons on the remote control are
dedicated to control the TV assigned to the TV CTRL
button. If you have two TVs, assign the main TV to the
TV CTRL button.
2
Press and hold the ENTER button for three seconds.
If the LED lights for one second, the erasing has been
successfully completed.
MULTI
RECEIVER
SOURCE
OPERATION
Default preset codes
R.SETUP
Input function button Preset code
BD
TV
DVD DVR/BDR HDMI
DVD
2 1 5 8
2 1 6 0
2 1 5 0
2 1 5 9
0 1 1 6
5 0 6 6
0 1 1 6
CD NET RADIO ADAPTER
BD
iPod USB TUNER SIRIUS
INPUT SELECT TV CTRL
XM
DVR/BDR
HDMI
TV
RECEIVER
MASTER
VOLUME
INPUT
CD
TV CONTROL
TV CTRL
CH
VOL
MUTE
AUDIO
VIDEO
PARAMETER
PARAMETER
LIST TUNE TOOLS
TOP MENU
BAND
T.EDIT
GUIDE
PRESET
ENTER
PRESET
CATEGORY
RETURN
HOME
TUNE
MENU
iPod CTRL
AUTO /ALC
/
PGM MEMORY MENU
DIRECT STEREO STANDARD ADV SURR
HDD
DVD
THX
PHASE CTRL
STATUS
TV
/
DTV
MPX
PQLS
HDMI OUT
2
AUDIO
1
3
SIGNAL SEL MCACC SLEEP
INFO
DISP
4
5
6
CH LEVEL A.ATT DIMMER
7
8
9
CH
D.ACCESS
CLASS
ENTER
/
CLR
0
ZONE 2
ZONE 3
LIGHT
RECEIVER
Note
1 When preset codes are set, all the signals learned in the input function buttons are cleared. This function is convenient when you want to reset
some but not all of input function buttons.
72
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controlling the rest of your system
09
Button(s)
TV
TV (Monitor)
BD/DVD
HDD/DVR
VCR
SAT/CATV
SOURCE
POWER ON/OFF POWER ON/OFF POWER ON/OFF POWER ON/OFF POWER ON/OFF POWER ON/OFF
Number buttons numerics
numerics
numerics
CLEAR
numerics
+
numerics
numerics
• (dot)
• (dot)
KURO LINK
CH ENTER
-
-
ENTER
ENTER
ENTER
ENTER
ENTER
(CLASS)
EXIT/INFO
EXIT
TOP MENU
TOOLS
TOP MENU
GUIDE
-
-
LIST
TOOLS/GUIDE/
EPG
USER MENU
GUIDE
///
///
ENTER
///
ENTER
///
ENTER
///
ENTER
-
-
-
///
ENTER
ENTER
HOME MENU
HOME MENU
HOME MENU
HOME MENU
HOME / MENU
RETURN
RETURN
RETURN
RETURN
-
RETURN
HDD (Red)
DVD (Green)
(Yellow)
(Blue)
Red
Red
-
HDD
DVD
VCR
MENU
-
Red
Green
Green
-
-
Green
Yellow
Blue
Yellow
Yellow
-
-
Blue
Blue
MENU
-
-
-
-
AUTO SETUP
FREEZE
-
-
-
AUDIO
DISPLAY
-
-
ANT
-
AV SELECTION
SCREEN SIZE
AUDIO
-
-
AUDIO
DISP
AUDIO
DISPLAY
CH+/
AUDIO
DISPLAY
CH+/
AUDIO
-
AUDIO
DISPLAY/INFO
CH+/
DISPLAY
CH+/
CH +/–
OUTPUT
CH+/
RESOLUTION
a
+/
a. Controls for BD.
73
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controlling the rest of your system
09
Button(s)
LD
CD/CD-R/SACD
MD/DAT
TAPE
Button(s)
TV (Projector)
POWER ON
MOVIE
SOURCE
POWER ON/OFF POWER ON/OFF POWER ON/OFF POWER ON/OFF
SOURCE
Number buttons numerics
numerics
numerics
-
1
b
• (dot)
+10
>10/CLEAR
DISC/ENTER
CLEAR
CLEAR
ENTER
2
STANDARD
DYNAMIC
USER1
b
ENTER
(CLASS)
ENTER
OPEN/CLOSE
3
4
TOP MENU
-
-
-
-
MS
5
USER2
6
USER3
a
MS
LEGATO LINK
7
COLOR+
SHARP+
GAMMA
COLOR
///
///
-
-
-
-
///
8
ENTER
ENTER
-
-
-
9
a
SACD SETUP
-
0
• (dot)
SHARP
RETURN
-
-
-
ENTER (CLASS) COLOR TEMP
EXIT
INFO
AUDIO
DISP
-
-
///
///
ENTER
ENTER
TEST
a
AUDIO
DISPLAY/INFO
PURE AUDIO
HIDE
a
TIME
-
-
MENU
a. Controls for SACD.
b. Controls for MD.
HDMI1
HDMI2
COMP.
VIDEO
S-VIDEO
BRIGHT
BRIGHT+
POWER OFF
ASPECT
CONTRAST+/
AUDIO
DISP
CH +/–
74
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Advanced MCACC menu
10
Chapter 10:
The Advanced MCACC menu
Making receiver settings from the
Advanced MCACC menu
Automatic MCACC (Expert)
If your setup requires more detailed settings than those
provided in Automatically conducting optimum sound
tuning (Full Auto MCACC) on page 38, you can customize
your setup options below. You can calibrate your system
differently for up to six different MCACC presets, which
are useful if you have different listening positions
depending on the type of source (for example, watching
movies from a sofa, or playing a video game close to the
TV).
The Advanced MCACC (Multi Channel ACoustic
Calibration) system was developed in Pioneer’s
laboratories with the aim of making it possible for home
users to perform adjustments of the same level as in a
studio easily and with high precision. The acoustic
characteristics of the listening environment are
measured and the frequency response is calibrated
accordingly to allow high precision, automatic analysis
and optimal calibration of the sound field to bring it
closer to a studio environment than ever before.
Furthermore, while it was previously difficult to eliminate
standing waves, this receiver is equipped with a standing
wave control function using a unique process to perform
acoustic analysis and reduce their influence.
Important
• Make sure the microphone/speakers are not moved
during the Auto MCACC Setup.
• The screen saver will automatically appear after five
minutes of inactivity.
This section describes how to calibrate the sound field
automatically and fine-adjust the sound field data
manually.
CAUTION
• The test tones used in the Auto MCACC Setup are
output at high volume.
1
Switch on the receiver and your TV.
Make sure that the TV’s video input is set to this receiver.
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then press
®
2
Press
THX
HOME MENU
.
THX is a trademark of THX Ltd., which may be registered
in some jurisdictions. All rights reserved.
A Graphical User Interface (GUI) screen appears on your
TV. Use /// and ENTER to navigate through the
screens and select menu items. Press RETURN to
confirm and exit the current menu.
1
Select ‘Auto MCACC’ from the Advanced MCACC
menu, then press ENTER
.
• Press HOME MENU at any time to exit the Home
If the Advanced MCACC screen is not displayed, refer to
Making receiver settings from the Advanced MCACC menu
above.
Menu.
3
Select ‘Advanced MCACC’ from the Home Menu
then press ENTER
,
.
4
Select the setting you want to adjust.
Full Auto MCACC – See Automatically conducting
•
optimum sound tuning (Full Auto MCACC) on page 38
for a quick and effective automatic surround setup.
• Auto MCACC – See Automatic MCACC (Expert)
below for a more detailed MCACC setup.
• Manual MCACC – Fine-tunes your speaker settings
and customizes the Acoustic Calibration EQ (see
Manual MCACC setup on page 77).
• Demo – No settings are saved and no errors occur.
When the speakers are connected to this receiver,
the test tone is output repeatedly. Press RETURN to
cancel the test tone.
75
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Advanced MCACC menu
10
2
Select the parameters you want to set.
3
Connect the microphone to the MCACC SETUP MIC
Use / to select the item, then use / to set.
• Auto MCACC – The default is ALL (recommended),
jack on the front panel.
Make sure there are no obstacles between the speakers
and the microphone.
but you can limit the system calibration to only one
1
setting (to save time) if you want.
AUDIO
PARAMETER
(TUNE)
VIDEO
CONTROL ON/OFF
TUNER EDIT
BAND AUTO SURR/ALC/ HOME STANDARD ADVANCED STEREO
MULTI-ZONE
SPEAKERS
• EQ Type (only available when the Auto MCACC
Menu above is EQ Pro & S-Wave) – This determines
how the frequency balance is adjusted.
STREAM DIRECT THX
SURROUND SURROUND
(PRESET)
ENTER
(TUNE)
(PRESET)
iPod
iPhone
HDMI
5
USB
MCACC
SETUP MIC
VIDEO CAMERA
PHONES
HOME MENU
RETURN
After a single calibration is performed, each of the
following three correction curves can be stored
separately in the MCACC memory. SYMMETRY
implements symmetric correction for each pair of left
and right speakers to flatten the frequency-amplitude
characteristics. ALL CH ADJ is a ‘flat’ setting where all
the speakers are set individually so no special weighting
Microphone
Tripod
2
is given to any one channel. FRONT ALIGN sets all
speakers in accordance with the front speaker settings
(no equalization is applied to the front left and right
channels).
If you have a tripod, use it to place the microphone so that
it’s about ear level at your normal listening position. If you
do not have a tripod, use some other object to install the
3
• THX Speaker (only available when the Auto MCACC
Menu above is ALL or Speaker Setting) – Select YES
if you are using THX speakers (set all speakers to
SMALL), otherwise leave it set to NO.
microphone.
4
When you’re finished setting the options, select
START then press ENTER
.
• STAND.WAVE Multi-Point (only available when the
Auto MCACC Menu above is EQ Pro & S-Wave) – In
addition to measurements at the listening position,
you can use two more reference points for which test
tones will be analyzed for standing waves. This is
useful if you want to get a balanced ‘flat’ calibration
for several seating positions in your listening area.
Place the microphone at the reference point
indicated on-screen and note that the last
5
6
Follow the instructions on-screen.
Wait for the Auto MCACC Setup to finish
outputting test tones.
A progress report is displayed on-screen while the
receiver outputs test tones to determine the speakers
present in your setup. Try to be as quiet as possible while
4
it’s doing this.
• With error messages (such as Too much ambient
noise! or Check microphone) select RETRY after
checking for ambient noise (see Problems when
using the Auto MCACC Setup on page 40) and
verifying the mic connection. If there doesn’t seem to
be a problem, you can simply select GO NEXT and
continue.
microphone placement will be at your main listening
position:
2nd reference
3rd reference
point
point
1
2
7
If necessary, confirm the speaker configuration in
the GUI screen.
The configuration shown on-screen should reflect the
actual speakers you have.
3
Main listening
position
Note
1 • When data measurement is taken (after selecting ALL or Keep SP System), the reverb characteristics data (both before- and after-
calibration) that this receiver had been storing will be overwritten. If you want to save the reverb characteristics data before measuring,
connect a USB memory device to this receiver and transfer the data.
• When measurement is taken of data other than SYMMETRY (after selecting ALL or Keep SP System), the data are not measured after the
correction. If you will need to measure after correction data, take the measurement using the EQ Professional menu in the Manual MCACC
setup (page 77).
• The EQ Pro & S-Wave measurement is also taken when Keep SP System or EQ Pro & S-Wave is selected. See Acoustic Calibration EQ
Professional on page 79 for more on this.
• Either effect of Acoustic Calibration EQ Professional and Standing Wave can be switched on and off in the respective MCACC preset. For
details, see Setting the Audio options on page 60.
2 If you selected ALL or Keep SP System as your Auto MCACC menu, you can specify the MCACC preset where you want to save the
SYMMETRY, ALL CH ADJ and FRONT ALIGN settings.
3 It may not be possible to measure correctly if the microphone is placed on a table, sofa, etc.
4 Do not adjust the volume during the test tones. This may result in incorrect speaker settings.
76
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Advanced MCACC menu
10
If no operations are performed for 10 seconds while the
speaker configuration check screen is being displayed,
the Auto MCACC Setup will resume automatically. In this
case, you don’t need to select ‘OK’ and press ENTER in
step 8.
Manual MCACC setup
You can use the settings in the Manual MCACC setup
menu to make detailed adjustments when you’re more
familiar with the system. Before making these settings,
you should have already completed Automatically
conducting optimum sound tuning (Full Auto MCACC) on
page 38.
• If you see an ERR message (or the speaker
configuration displayed isn’t correct), there may be a
problem with the speaker connection.
If selecting RETRY doesn’t work, turn off the power
and check the speaker connections. If there doesn’t
seem to be a problem, you can simply use / to
select the speaker and / to change the setting
and continue.
You only need to make these settings once (unless you
change the placement of your current speaker system or
add new speakers).
CAUTION
• If Reverse Phase is displayed, the speaker’s wiring
(+ and –) may be inverted. Check the speaker
connections.
• The test tones used in the Manual MCACC setup are
output at high volume.
1
– If the connections were wrong, turn off the power,
disconnect the power cord, then reconnect properly.
After this, perform the Full Auto MCACC procedure
again.
– If the connections were right, select GO NEXT and
continue.
Important
• Press the MCACC button while the pertinent setup
screens are displayed to select MCACC presets.
• For some of the settings below, you’ll have to connect
the setup microphone to the front panel and place it
about ear level at your normal listening position.
Press HOME MENU to display the Home Menu
before you connect the microphone to this receiver.
8
Make sure ‘OK’ is selected, then press ENTER.
A progress report is displayed on-screen while the
receiver outputs more test tones to determine the
optimum receiver settings.
• See Problems when using the Auto MCACC Setup on
page 40 for notes regarding high background noise
levels and other possible interference.
Again, try to be as quiet as possible while this is
happening. It may take 3 to 7 minutes.
• If you selected a STAND.WAVE Multi-Point setup
(in step 2), you will be asked to place the mic at the
2nd and 3rd reference points before finally placing it
at your main listening position.
• If you’re using a subwoofer, switch it on and turn up
the volume to the middle position.
1
Select ‘Manual MCACC’ from the Advanced
MCACC menu.
9
The Auto MCACC Setup procedure is completed and
See Making receiver settings from the Advanced MCACC
menu on page 75 if you’re not already at this screen.
the Advanced MCACC menu reappears automatically.
The settings made in the Auto MCACC Setup should give
you excellent surround sound from your system, but it is
also possible to adjust these settings manually using the
Manual MCACC setup menu (starting below) or Manual
2
Select the setting you want to adjust.
If you’re doing this for the first time, you might want to
make these settings in order.
2
SP Setup menu (starting on page 84).
• Fine Channel Level – Make fine adjustments to the
overall balance of your speaker system (see Fine
Channel Level on page 78).
You can also choose to view the settings by selecting
individual parameters from the MCACC Data Check
screen (see Checking MCACC Data on page 81).
• Fine SP Distance – Make precise delay settings for
your speaker system (see Fine Speaker Distance on
page 78).
Press RETURN after you have finished checking each
screen. When you’re finished, select RETURN to go back
to the Home Menu.
Be sure to disconnect the microphone from this receiver
upon completion of the Auto MCACC Setup.
Note
1 If the speaker is not pointed to the microphone (listening position) or when using speakers that affect the phase (dipole speakers, reflective
speakers, etc.), Reverse Phase may be displayed even if the speakers are properly connected.
2 • Depending on the characteristics of your room, sometimes identical speakers with cone sizes of around 12 cm (5 inches) will end up with
different size settings. You can correct the setting manually using the Manual speaker setup on page 84.
• The subwoofer distance setting may be farther than the actual distance from the listening position. This setting should be accurate (taking
delay and room characteristics into account) and generally does not need to be changed.
• If Auto MCACC Setup measurement results are incorrect due to the interaction of the speakers and viewing environment, we recommend
adjusting the settings manually.
77
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Advanced MCACC menu
10
• Standing Wave – Control overly resonant low
frequencies in your listening room (see Standing
Wave on page 78).
Fine Speaker Distance
• Default setting: 10’00” (all speakers)
For proper sound depth and separation with your system,
it is necessary to add a slight bit of delay to some
speakers so that all sounds will arrive at the listening
position at the same time. You can adjust the distance of
each speaker in half inch increments. The following
setting can help you make detailed adjustments that you
may not achieve using the Manual speaker setup on
page 84.
The last two settings are specifically for customizing the
parameters explained in Acoustic Calibration EQ Adjust
on page 79:
• EQ Adjust – Manually adjust the frequency balance
of your speaker system while listening to test tones
(see Acoustic Calibration EQ Adjust on page 79).
• EQ Professional – Calibrate your system based on
the direct sound coming from the speakers and make
detailed settings according to your room’s reverb
characteristics (see Acoustic Calibration EQ
Professional on page 79).
1
Select ‘Fine SP Distance’ from the Manual MCACC
setup menu.
2
Adjust the distance of the left channel from the
listening position.
Fine Channel Level
• Default setting: 0.0dB (all channels)
3
Select each channel in turn and adjust the distance
as necessary.
Use / to adjust the delay of the speaker you selected
You can achieve better surround sound by properly
adjusting the overall balance of your speaker system. You
can adjust the Channel Level of each speaker in 0.5 dB
increments. The following setting can help you make
detailed adjustments that you may not achieve using the
Manual speaker setup on page 84.
to match the reference speaker.
Listen to the reference speaker and use it to measure the
target channel. From the listening position, face the two
speakers with your arms outstretched pointing at each
speaker. Try to make the two tones sound as if they are
arriving simultaneously at a position slightly in front of
1
Select ‘Fine Channel Level’ from the Manual
1
you and between your arm span.
MCACC setup menu.
The volume increases to the 0.0 dB reference level.
2
Adjust the level of the left channel.
This will be the reference speaker level, so you may want
to keep the level around 0.0dB so that you’ll have plenty
of room to adjust the other speaker levels.
When it sounds like the delay settings are matched up,
press to confirm and continue to the next channel.
• For comparison purposes, the reference speaker will
change depending on which speaker you select.
• After pressing ENTER, test tones will be output.
3
Select each channel in turn and adjust the levels (+/
–12.0 dB) as necessary.
Use / to adjust the volume of the speaker you
selected to match the reference speaker. When it sounds
like both tones are the same volume, press to confirm
and continue to the next channel.
• If you want to go back and adjust a channel, simply
use / to select it.
4
When you’re finished, press RETURN.
• For comparison purposes, the reference speaker will
change depending on which speaker you select.
You will return to the Manual MCACC setup menu.
Standing Wave
• If you want to go back and adjust a channel, simply
use / to select it.
2
• Default setting: ON /ATT 0.0dB (all filters)
Acoustic standing waves occur when, under certain
conditions, sound waves from your speaker system
resonate mutually with sound waves reflected off the
walls in your listening area. This can have a negative
effect on the overall sound, especially at certain lower
frequencies. Depending on speaker placement, your
listening position, and ultimately the shape of your room,
4
When you’re finished, press RETURN.
You will return to the Manual MCACC setup menu.
Note
1 • If you can’t seem to achieve this by adjusting the distance setting, you may need to change the angle of your speakers very slightly.
• For better audibility, the subwoofer emits a continuous test tone (oscillating pulses are heard from your other speakers). Note that it may be
difficult to compare this tone with the other speakers in your setup (depending on the low frequency response of the reference speaker).
2 You can switch on or off the Standing Wave and Acoustic Calibration EQ feature in the AUDIO PARAMETER menu. See Setting the Audio
options on page 60 for more on this.
78
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Advanced MCACC menu
10
it results in an overly resonant (‘boomy’) sound. The
Standing Wave Control uses filters to reduce the effect of
overly resonant sounds in your listening area. During
playback of a source, you can customize the filters used
for Standing Wave Control for each of your MCACC
Tip
• Changing the frequency curve of one channel too
drastically will affect the overall balance. If the speaker
balance seems uneven, you can raise or lower channel
levels using test tones with the TRIM feature. Use /
to select TRIM, then use / to raise or lower the
channel level for the current speaker.
1
presets.
1
Select ‘Standing Wave’ from the Manual MCACC
setup menu.
3
When you’re finished, press RETURN.
2
Adjust the parameters for the Standing Wave
You will return to the Manual MCACC setup menu.
Control.
• Filter Channel – Select the channel to which you will
apply the filter(s): MAIN (all except center channel
and subwoofer), Center or SW (subwoofer).
Acoustic Calibration EQ Professional
This setup minimizes the unwanted effects of room
reverberation by allowing you to calibrate your system
based on the direct sound coming from the speakers.
• TRIM (only available when the filter channel above is
SW) – Adjust the subwoofer channel level (to
compensate for the difference in output post-filter).
How to use Acoustic Calibration EQ Professional
If you find that lower frequencies seem overly reverberant
in your listening room (i.e. it sounds ‘boomy’), or that
different channels seem to exhibit different reverb
characteristics (when Type A or Type B shown on the
diagrams on the following applies), select EQ Pro. & S-
Wave (or ALL) for the Auto MCACC setting in Automatic
MCACC (Expert) on page 75 to calibrate the room
automatically.
• Freq / Q / ATT – These are the filter parameters where
Freq represents the frequency you will be targeting
and Q is the bandwidth (the higher the Q, the
narrower the bandwidth, or range) of the attenuation
(ATT, the amount of reduction to the targeted
frequency).
3
When you’re finished, press RETURN.
You will return to the Manual MCACC setup menu.
• Type A: Reverberance of high vs. low frequencies
Acoustic Calibration EQ Adjust
• Default setting: ON/0.0dB (all channels/bands)
Low
Level
frequencies
Acoustic Calibration Equalization is a kind of room
equalizer for your speakers (excluding the subwoofer). It
works by measuring the acoustic characteristics of your
room and neutralizing the ambient characteristics that
can color the original source material (providing a ‘flat’
equalization setting). If you’re not satisfied with the
adjustment provided in Automatically conducting
optimum sound tuning (Full Auto MCACC) on page 38 or
Automatic MCACC (Expert) on page 75, you can also
adjust these settings manually to get a frequency
balance that suits your tastes.
High
frequencies
Acoustic Cal. EQ Pro.
ConventionalMCACC
EQ calibration range
calibration range
Time
(in msec)
0
80
160
• Type B: Reverb characteristics for different
channels
Front L
Level
Front R
1
Select ‘EQ Adjust’ from the Manual MCACC setup
menu.
Acoustic Cal. EQ Pro.
ConventionalMCACC
calibration range
EQ calibration range
2
Select the channel(s) you want and adjust to your
Time
liking.
0
80
160
(in msec)
Use / to select the channel.
Use / to select the frequency and / to boost or
cut the EQ. When you’re finished, go back to the top of
the screen and press to return to Ch, then use / to
select the channel.
If the pattern is as shown above, select the 30-50ms
setting. If not, this setting is not necessary.
• The OVER! indicator shows in the display if the
frequency adjustment is too drastic and might
distort. If this happens, bring the level down until
OVER! disappears from the display.
Note
1 Standing Wave control filter settings cannot be changed during playback of sources using the HDMI connection.
79
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Advanced MCACC menu
10
4
If you selected ‘Reverb View’, you can check the
Using Acoustic Calibration EQ Professional
reverb characteristics for each channel. Press RETURN
when you’re done.
1
2
Select ‘EQ Professional’, then press ENTER
Select an option and press ENTER
• Reverb Measurement – Use this to measure the
reverb characteristics before and after calibration.
.
The reverb characteristics are displayed when the Full
Auto MCACC or Reverb Measurement measurements
.
4
are conducted.
Use / to select the channel, frequency and
calibration setting you want to check. Use / to go
back and forth between the three. The reverb
characteristics graph before and after EQ calibration can
be displayed by selecting Calibration : Before / After.
Note that the markers on the vertical axis indicate
decibels in 2 dB steps.
• Reverb View – You can check the reverb
measurements made for specified frequency ranges
1
in each channel.
• Advanced EQ Setup – Use this to select the time
period that will be used for frequency adjustment and
calibration, based on the reverb measurement of
your listening area. Note that customizing system
calibration using this setup will alter the settings you
made in Automatically conducting optimum sound
tuning (Full Auto MCACC) on page 38 or Automatic
MCACC (Expert) on page 75 and is not necessary if
you’re satisfied with these settings.
5
If ‘Advanced EQ Setup’ is selected, select the
MCACC memory to be stored, then enter the desired
time setting for calibration, and then select START 5
.
Based on the reverb measurement above, you can
choose the time period that will be used for the final
frequency adjustment and calibration. Even though you
can make this setting without reverb measurement, it is
best to use the measurement results as a reference for
your time setting. For an optimal system calibration
based on the direct sound coming from the speakers, we
recommend using the 30-50ms setting.
3
If you selected ‘Reverb Measurement’, select EQ
ON or OFF, and then START
.
The following options determine how the reverb
characteristics of your listening area are displayed in
Reverb View:
• EQ OFF – You will see the reverb characteristics of
your listening area without the equalization
performed by this receiver (before calibration).
Use / to select the setting. Use / to switch
between them.
Select the setting from the following time periods (in
milliseconds): 0-20ms, 10-30ms, 20-40ms, 30-50ms, 40-
60ms, 50-70ms and 60-80ms. This setting will be applied
to all channels during calibration.
• EQ ON – You will see the reverb characteristics of
your listening area with the equalization performed
2
by this receiver (after calibration). Note that the EQ
response may not appear entirely flat due to
adjustments necessary for your listening area.
3
When you’re finished, select START. It will take about 2
to 4 minutes for the calibration to finish.
When the reverb measurement is finished, you can select
Reverb View to see the results on-screen. See
Professional Calibration EQ graphical output on page 96
for troubleshooting information.
After the Acoustic Calibration Equalization is set, you are
given the option to check the settings on-screen.
Note
1 If the Reverb View procedure is performed after the Automatically conducting optimum sound tuning (Full Auto MCACC) on page 38 or
Reverb Measurement operation, depending on the standing wave control setting, differences may appear on the reverb graph. With the Auto
MCACC function, the reverberations are measured with the standing waves controlled, so the reverb characteristics graph shows the
characteristics with the effect of the standing waves eliminated. By contrast, the Reverb Measurement function measures the reverberations
without controlling the standing waves, so the graph indicates the reverb characteristics including the effect of the standing waves. If you wish
to check the reverb characteristics of the room itself (with the standing waves as such), we recommend using the Reverb Measurement
function.
2 • The calibration corresponding to the currently selected MCACC preset will be used when EQ ON is selected. To use another MCACC preset,
press MCACC to select the MCACC memory you want to store.
• The predicted reverb characteristics after calibration can be acquired with the Full Auto MCACC function (Automatically conducting
optimum sound tuning (Full Auto MCACC) on page 38), but here the actually measured reverb characteristics after calibration can be acquired.
3 After auto calibration with EQ Type : SYMMETRY (Full Auto MCACC, etc.), the graph for the inferred reverb characteristics can be displayed
by selecting Reverb View. To display the actually measured reverb characteristics after EQ calibration, measure with EQ ON.
4 The After display when measurements have been made using the Full Auto MCACC or Auto MCACC (ALL or KEEP SP system) function
shows the graph for the inferred reverb characteristics after EQ Type : SYMMETRY calibration.
5 To specify the place where the MCACC memory is to be stored, press MCACC to select the MCACC memory you want to store.
80
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Advanced MCACC menu
Checking MCACC Data
10
Channel Level
Use this to display the level of the various channels. See
Channel Level on page 86 for more on this.
At the procedure of Automatically conducting optimum
sound tuning (Full Auto MCACC) on page 38, the
procedure of Automatic MCACC (Expert) on page 75 or
after fine-adjusting at Manual MCACC setup on page 77,
you can check your calibrated settings using the GUI
screen. The data can be transferred to a computer using
a USB device to check it on the computer’s screen as
well.
1
Select ‘Channel Level’ from the MCACC Data
Check menu.
2
When ‘MCACC’ is highlighted, use / to select
the MCACC preset you want to check.
The level of the various channels set at the selected
MCACC preset is displayed. ‘---’ is displayed for channels
that are not connected.
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then press
1
Press
HOME MENU
.
Speaker Distance
A Graphical User Interface (GUI) screen appears on your
TV. Use /// and ENTER to navigate through the
screens and select menu items. Press RETURN to
confirm and exit the current menu.
Use this to display the distance from the different
channels to the listening position. See Speaker Distance
on page 86 for more on this.
1
Select ‘Speaker Distance’ from the MCACC Data
2
3
Select ‘MCACC Data Check’ from the Home Menu
.
Check menu.
Select the setting you want to check.
2
When ‘MCACC’ is highlighted, use / to select
• Speaker Setting – Used to check the settings of the
speaker systems. See Speaker Setting on page 81 for
more on this.
the MCACC preset you want to check.
The distance from the various channels set at the
selected MCACC preset is displayed. ‘---’ is displayed for
channels that are not connected.
• Channel Level – Used to check the output level of the
different speakers. See Channel Level on page 81 for
more on this.
Standing Wave
• Speaker Distance – Used to check the distance to
the different speakers. See Speaker Distance on
page 81 for more on this.
Use this to display the standing wave related adjustment
values for the various MCACC memories. See Standing
Wave on page 78 for more on this.
• Standing Wave – Used to check the standing wave
control filter settings. See Standing Wave on page 81
for more on this.
1
Select ‘Standing Wave’ from the MCACC Data
Check menu.
2
When ‘Filter Channel’ is highlighted, use / to
• Acoustic Cal EQ – Used to check the calibration
values of the listening environment’s frequency
response. See Acoustic Cal EQ on page 81 for more on
this.
select the channel for which you want to check
standing wave control.
The standing wave related calibration value for the
selected channel stored at the selected MCACC preset
and its graph are displayed.
• Output MCACC data – See Output MCACC data on
page 82 for more on this.
3
Press
to highlight ‘MCACC’, then use / to
4
Press RETURN to go back to the MCACC Data
Check menu, repeating steps 2 and 3 to check other
settings.
select the MCACC preset you want to check.
Acoustic Cal EQ
Use this to display the calibration values for the
frequency response of the various channels set in the
different MCACC presets. See Acoustic Calibration EQ
Adjust on page 79 for more on this.
5
When you’re finished, press RETURN.
You will return to the Home Menu.
Speaker Setting
Use this to display the speaker size and number of
speakers. See Speaker Setting on page 85 for more on this.
1
Select ‘Acoustic Cal EQ’ from the MCACC Data
Check menu.
1
Select ‘Speaker Setting’ from the MCACC Data
2
When ‘Ch’ is highlighted, use / to select the
Check menu.
channel.
The calibration value for the frequency response of the
selected channel stored at the selected MCACC preset
and its graph are displayed.
2
Select the channel you want to check.
Use / to select the channel. The corresponding
channel on the layout diagram is highlighted.
81
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Advanced MCACC menu
10
3
Press
to highlight ‘MCACC’, then use / to
select the MCACC preset you want to check.
Data Management
This system allows you to store up to six MCACC presets,
allowing you to calibrate your system for different
listening positions (or frequency adjustments for the
Output MCACC data
Before continuing, make sure you have completed step 2
in Checking MCACC Data on page 81. The data measured
with the Advanced MCACC function is transmitted to the
3
same listening position). This is useful for alternate
settings to match the kind of source you’re listening to
and where you’re sitting (for example, watching movies
from a sofa, or playing a video game close to the TV).
1
USB device. The 3D graphs of the reverb characteristics
before and after calibration and the MCACC results
(parameters) can be checked on your computer.
From this menu you can copy from one preset to another,
name presets for easier identification and clear any ones
you don’t need.
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then press
1
Press
HOME MENU
.
A Graphical User Interface (GUI) screen appears on your
TV. Use /// and ENTER to navigate through the
screens and select menu items. Press RETURN to
confirm and exit the current menu.
2
3
Select ‘Data Management’ from the Home Menu.
Select the setting you want to adjust.
• Memory Rename – Name your MCACC presets for
easy identification (see Renaming MCACC presets
below).
1
Select ‘Output MCACC data’ from the MCACC
Data Check menu.
When the receiver is ready for transmission, “Please
connect your USB memory for the MCACC data, then
press OK to output them.” shows on the GUI screen.
• MCACC Memory Copy – Copy settings from one
MCACC preset to another (see Copying MCACC
preset data on page 83).
2
Connect your USB device to the USB terminal on the
• MCACC Memory Clear – Clear any MCACC presets
that you don’t want (see Clearing MCACC presets on
page 83).
front panel, then select “OK”.
“Please wait...” will be displayed on the screen and
transmission of measurement data to the USB device will
begin.
Renaming MCACC presets
Transmission is complete when “Complete” is
If you have several different MCACC presets that you’re
using, you may want to rename them for easier
identification.
2
displayed.
1
Select ‘Memory Rename’ from the Data
Management setup menu.
2
Select the MCACC preset you want to rename, then
select an appropriate preset name.
Use / to select the preset, then / to select a
preset name.
3
Repeat for as many MCACC presets as necessary,
then press RETURN when you’re finished.
You will return to the Data Management setup menu.
Note
1 MCACC data and parameters are transferred from this receiver to a USB device and by connecting the USB device to a computer, the data is
imported via the MCACC software in the computer. See Connecting a USB device for Advanced MCACC output on page 35 for more on this.
2 Only one set of reverb characteristics is stored on the receiver. If you wish to compare several different measurement results, transmit the
data to the USB memory each time reverb measurements are taken.
3 This can be done in Automatically conducting optimum sound tuning (Full Auto MCACC) on page 38 or Automatic MCACC (Expert) on page 75,
either of which you should have already completed.
82
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Advanced MCACC menu
10
Copying MCACC preset data
If you want to manually adjust the Acoustic Calibration
EQ (see Manual MCACC setup on page 77), we
1
recommend copying your current settings to an unused
MCACC preset. Instead of just a flat EQ curve, this will
give you a reference point from which to start.
1
Select ‘MCACC Memory Copy’ from the Data
Management setup menu.
2
3
Select the setting you want to copy.
• All Data – Copies all the settings of the selected
MCACC preset memory.
• Level & Distance – Copies only the channel level and
speaker distance settings of the selected MCACC
preset memory.
Select the MCACC preset you’ll be copying the
settings ‘From’, then specify where you want to copy
them (‘To’).
Make sure you don’t overwrite an MCACC preset you’re
currently using (this can’t be undone).
4
Select ‘OK’ to confirm and copy the settings.
When MCACC Memory Copy? is displayed, select YES.
If NO is selected, the memory is not copied.
Completed! shows in the GUI screen to confirm the
MCACC preset has been copied, then you automatically
return to the Data Management setup menu.
Clearing MCACC presets
If you are no longer using one of the MCACC presets
stored in memory, you can choose to clear the calibration
settings of that preset.
1
Select ‘MCACC Memory Clear’ from the Data
Management setup menu.
2
Select the MCACC preset you want to clear.
Make sure you don’t clear an MCACC preset you’re
currently using (this can’t be undone).
3
Select ‘OK’ to confirm and clear the preset.
When MCACC Memory Clear? is displayed, select YES.
If NO is selected, the memory is not cleared.
Completed! shows in the GUI screen to confirm the
MCACC preset has been cleared, then you automatically
return to the Data Management setup menu.
Note
1 The settings made in Automatically conducting optimum sound tuning (Full Auto MCACC) on page 38 or Automatic MCACC (Expert) on page 75.
83
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The System Setup and Other Setup menus
11
Chapter 11:
The System Setup and Other Setup
menus
Making receiver settings from the
System Setup menu
Manual speaker setup
This receiver allows you to make detailed settings to
optimize the surround sound performance. You only need
to make these settings once (unless you change the
placement of your current speaker system or add new
speakers).
The following section describes how to change the
speaker-related settings manually and make various
other settings (input selection, OSD language selection,
etc.).
These settings are designed to customize your system,
but if you’re satisfied with the settings made in
Automatically conducting optimum sound tuning (Full
Auto MCACC) on page 38, it isn’t necessary to make all of
these settings.
1
Switch on the receiver and your TV.
Make sure that the TV’s video input is set to this receiver.
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then press
2
Press
HOME MENU
.
A Graphical User Interface (GUI) screen appears on your
TV. Use /// and ENTER to navigate through the
screens and select menu items. Press RETURN to
confirm and exit the current menu.
CAUTION
• The test tones used in the Manual SP Setup are
output at high volume.
• Press HOME MENU at any time to exit the Home
Menu.
1
Select ‘Manual SP Setup’, then press ENTER.
See Making receiver settings from the System Setup menu
above if you’re not already at this screen.
3
Select ‘System Setup’ from the Home Menu, then
press ENTER
.
2
Select the setting you want to adjust.
If you are doing this for the first time, you may want to
adjust these settings in order:
4
Select the setting you want to adjust.
• Manual SP Setup – Sets the type of connection used
for surround back terminals and the size, number
distance and overall balance of the connected
speakers (see Manual speaker setup below).
• Speaker System – Specifies how you are using your
surround back speakers (page 85).
• Speaker Setting – Specifies the size and number of
speakers you’ve connected (page 85).
• Input Setup – Specifies what you’ve connected to
the digital, HDMI and component video inputs (see
The Input Setup menu on page 40).
• Channel Level – Adjusts the overall balance of your
speaker system (page 86).
• OSD Language – The GUI screen’s display language
can be changed (see Changing the OSD display
language (OSD Language) on page 38).
• Speaker Distance – Specifies the distance of your
speakers from the listening position (page 86).
• X-Curve – Adjusts the tonal balance of your speaker
system for movie soundtracks (page 87).
• Network Setup – Conducts the setup necessary to
connect this unit to the network (see Network Setup
menu on page 87).
• THX Audio Setting – Specifies whether you are
using a THX speaker setup (page 87).
• Other Setup – Makes customized settings to reflect
how you are using the receiver (see The Other Setup
menu on page 89).
3
Make the adjustments necessary for each setting,
pressing RETURN to confirm after each screen.
84
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The System Setup and Other Setup menus
11
4
When ‘Setting Change?’ is displayed, select Yes.
Speaker system setting
• Default setting: Normal(SB/FH)
If No is selected, the setting is not changed.
You will return to the Manual SP Setup menu.
There are several ways you can use the speaker terminals
with this receiver. In addition to a normal home theater
setup where they are used for the front height speakers
or front wide speakers, they can be used for bi-amping
the front speakers or as an independent speaker system
in another room.
Speaker Setting
Use this setting to specify your speaker configuration
2
(size, number of speakers and crossover frequency) . It is
a good idea to make sure that the settings made in
Automatically conducting optimum sound tuning (Full
Auto MCACC) on page 38 are correct. Note that this
setting applies to all MCACC presets, and cannot be set
independently.
1
Select ‘Speaker System’ from the Manual SP Setup
menu.
See Making receiver settings from the System Setup menu
on page 84 if you’re not already at this screen.
1
Select ‘Speaker Setting’ from the Manual SP Setup
2
Select the speaker system setting.
• Normal(SB/FH) – Select for normal home theater
use with front height speakers in your main (speaker
system A) setup.
menu.
2
Choose the set of speakers that you want to set,
then select a speaker size.
Use / to select the size (and number) of each of the
• Normal(SB/FW) – Select for normal home theater
use with front wide speakers in your main (speaker
system A) setup.
3
following speakers:
• Front – Select LARGE if your front speakers
reproduce bass frequencies effectively, or if you
didn’t connect a subwoofer. Select SMALL to send
the bass frequencies to the subwoofer.
• Speaker B – Select to use the B speaker terminals to
listen to stereo playback in another room (see
Switching the speaker terminals on page 63).
• Center – Select LARGE if your center speaker
reproduces bass frequencies effectively, or select
SMALL to send bass frequencies to the other
speakers or subwoofer. If you didn’t connect a center
speaker, choose NO (the center channel is sent to
the front speakers).
• Front Bi-Amp – Select this setting if you’re bi-
amping your front speakers (see Bi-amping your
speakers on page 21).
• ZONE 2 – Select to use the (surround back) B
speaker terminals for an independent system in
another zone (see Using the MULTI-ZONE controls on
page 63).
• FH – Select LARGE if your front height speakers
reproduce bass frequencies effectively, or select
SMALL to send bass frequencies to the other
speakers or subwoofer. If you didn’t connect front
height speakers, choose NO (the front height
3
If you selected Normal(SB/FH), Normal(SB/FW), or
Speaker B in Step 2, select the placement of the
surround speakers.
In a 7.1-channel surround system with surround
speakers placed directly at the sides of the listening
position, the surround sound of 5.1-channel sources is
heard from the side. This function mixes the sound of the
surround speakers with the surround back speakers so
that the surround sound is heard from diagonally to the
4
channel is sent to the front speakers).
• FW – Select LARGE if your front wide speakers
reproduce bass frequencies effectively, or select
SMALL to send bass frequencies to the other
speakers or subwoofer. If you didn’t connect front
wide speakers, choose NO (the front wide channel is
1
rear as it should be.
5
sent to the front speakers).
• ON SIDE – Select when the surround speakers is
positioned right beside you.
• IN REAR – Select when the surround speaker is
positioned obliquely behind you.
Note
1 Depending on the positions of the speakers and the sound source, in some cases it may not be possible to achieve good results. In this case,
set the setting to ON SIDE or IN REAR.
2 If you’re using a THX speaker setup, set all speakers to SMALL.
3 If you select SMALL for the front speakers the subwoofer will automatically be fixed to YES. Also, the center, surround, surround back, front
height and front wide speakers can’t be set to LARGE if the front speakers are set to SMALL. In this case, all bass frequencies are sent to the
subwoofer.
4 • You can adjust this setting only when Speaker System setting is Normal(SB/FH).
• If the surround speakers are set to NO, this setting will automatically be set to NO.
5 • You can adjust this setting only when Speaker System setting is Normal(SB/FW).
• If the surround speakers are set to NO, this setting will automatically be set to NO.
85
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The System Setup and Other Setup menus
11
• Surr – Select LARGE if your surround speakers
reproduce bass frequencies effectively. Select
SMALL to send bass frequencies to the other
speakers or subwoofer. If you didn’t connect
surround speakers choose NO (the sound of the
surround channels is sent to the front speakers or a
subwoofer).
Channel Level
Using the channel level settings, you can adjust the
overall balance of your speaker system, an important
factor when setting up a home theater system.
1
Select ‘Channel Level’ from the Manual SP Setup
menu.
The test tones will start.
• SB – Select the number of surround back speakers
1
you have (one, two or none). Select LARGEx2 or
2
Adjust the level of each channel using /
.
LARGEx1 if your surround back speakers reproduce
bass frequencies effectively. Select SMALLx2 or
SMALLx1 to send bass frequencies to the other
speakers or subwoofer. If you didn’t connect
surround back speakers choose NO.
Use / to switch speakers.
Adjust the level of each speaker as the test tone is
4
emitted.
3
When you’re finished, press RETURN.
You will return to the Manual SP Setup menu.
• SW – LFE signals and bass frequencies of channels
set to SMALL are output from the subwoofer when
YES is selected. Choose the PLUS setting if you want
the subwoofer to output bass sound continuously or
you want deeper bass (the bass frequencies that
would normally come out the front and center
Tip
• You can change the channel levels by press
RECEIVER, then press CH LEVEL, and then using /
on the remote control.
2
speakers are also routed to the subwoofer). If you did
not connect a subwoofer choose NO (the bass
frequencies are output from other speakers).
Speaker Distance
For good sound depth and separation from your system,
you need to specify the distance of your speakers from
the listening position. The receiver can then add the
proper delay needed for effective surround sound.
3
Select ‘X. OVER’ and set the crossover frequency.3
Frequencies below this point will be sent to the
subwoofer (or LARGE speakers).
4
When you’re finished, press RETURN.
1
Select ‘Speaker Distance’ from the Manual SP
You will return to the Manual SP Setup menu.
Setup menu.
2
Adjust the distance of each speaker using /.
1
You can adjust the distance of each speaker in /2 inch
Increments.
3
When you’re finished, press RETURN.
You will return to the Manual SP Setup menu.
Tip
• For best surround sound, make sure the surround
back speakers are the same distance from the
listening position.
Note
1 • If you selected ZONE 2 or Front Bi-Amp (in Speaker system setting on page 85) you can’t adjust the surround back settings.
• If the surround speakers are set to NO, the surround back speakers will automatically be set to NO.
2 If you have a subwoofer and like lots of bass, it may seem logical to select LARGE for your front speakers and PLUS for the subwoofer. This
may not, however, yield the best bass results. Depending on the speaker placement of your room you may actually experience a decrease in
the amount of bass due low frequency cancellations. In this case, try changing the position or direction of speakers. If you can’t get good
results, listen to the bass response with it set to PLUS and YES or the front speakers set to LARGE and SMALL alternatively and let your ears
judge which sounds best. If you’re having problems, the easiest option is to route all the bass sounds to the subwoofer by selecting SMALL
for the front speakers.
3 • This setting decides the cutoff between bass sounds playing back from the speakers selected as LARGE, or the subwoofer, and bass sounds
playing back from those selected as SMALL. It also decides where the cutoff will be for bass sounds in the LFE channel.
• With Full Auto MCACC Setup or Auto MCACC Setup (ALL or Speaker Setting), the setting here will not apply and the crossover frequency
will be automatically set. Crossover frequency is a frequency aimed at achieving the optimal sound field taking into account the bass capacity
of all connected speakers and human aural characteristics.
• If you’re using THX speakers, confirm that the crossover frequency is set to 80Hz.
4 If you are using a Sound Pressure Level (SPL) meter, take the readings from your main listening position and adjust the level of each speaker
to 75 dB SPL (C-weighting/slow reading).
86
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The System Setup and Other Setup menus
11
5
Specify whether your subwoofer is Select2 certified
X-Curve
or not.
Most soundtracks mixed for cinema sound too bright
when played back in large rooms. The X-Curve setting acts
as a kind of re-equalization for home theater listening, and
restores proper tonal balance of movie soundtracks.1
If your subwoofer isn’t THX Select2 certified, but you still
want to switch boundary gain compensation on, select
YES here, but the effect might not work properly.
6
Select either ON or OFF for Boundary Gain
1
Select ‘X-Curve’ from the Manual SP Setup menu.
Compensation setting.
2
Choose the X-Curve setting you want.
7
When you’re finished, press RETURN.
Use / to adjust the setting. The X-Curve is expressed
as a downwards slope in decibels per octave, starting at
2 kHz. The sound becomes less bright as the slope
increases (to a maximum of –3.0dB/oct). Use the
following guidelines to set the X-Curve according to your
room size:
You will return to the Manual SP Setup menu.
Network Setup menu
Setting up the network to listen to Internet radio on this
receiver.
Room size (ft2)
≤400 ≤550 ≤650 ≤800 ≤2200 ≤12000
X-Curve (dB/oct) –0.5
–1.0
–1.5 –2.0
–2.5
–3.0
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then press
1
Press
HOME MENU
.
• If you select OFF, the frequency curve will be flat and
A Graphical User Interface (GUI) screen appears on your
TV. Use /// and ENTER to navigate through the
screens and select menu items. Press RETURN to
confirm and exit the current menu.
the X-Curve has no effect.
3
When you’re finished, press RETURN
.
THX Audio Setting
2
Select ‘System Setup’ from the Home Menu
.
This menu allows the user to adjust various THX features
including Loudness Plus, SBch processing, SB Speaker
Position, THX Select2 Subwoofer (on/off), and Boundary
Gain Control. Please see page 103 for details regarding
these THX features.
3
Select ‘Network Setup’ from the System Setup
menu.
4
Select the setting you want to adjust.
If you are doing this for the first time, you may want to
adjust these settings in order:
1
Select ‘THX Audio Setting’ from the Manual SP
setup menu.
• IP Address, Proxy – Sets up the IP address/Proxy of
this receiver (page 88).
2
Select either ON or OFF for the THX Loudness Plus
setting.
• Information – Checks the MAC address and the
firmware version of the Network section of this
receiver (page 88).
3
Specify whether the SBch processing is AUTO or
MANUAL.
• Network Standby – Allows the Web Control
function to be used even when the receiver is in the
standby mode (page 88).
• AUTO – When surround back speakers are connected,
whether or not surround back channel signals are
present in the audio signals being input is detected
and the appropriate THX surround mode is set.
• MANUAL – The desired THX surround mode can be
selected regardless of whether or not surround back
channel signals are present in the audio signals
being input.
4
Specify the distance of your surround back speakers
from each other.
• 0–1 ft – Surround back speakers within 1 foot apart.
• >1–4 ft – Surround back speakers between 1 and 4
feet apart.
• 4 ft< – Surround back speakers more than 4 feet
apart (default).
Note
1 Since the principal is the same, X-Curve isn’t applied when you’re using any of the Home THX or Pure direct modes.
87
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The System Setup and Other Setup menus
11
1
Select ‘IP Address, Proxy’ from the Network Setup
IP address/Proxy setting
menu.
In case the router connected to the LAN terminal on this
receiver is a broadband router (with a built-in DHCP
server function), simply turn on the DHCP server
function, and you will not need to set up the network
manually. You must set up the network as described
below only when you have connected this receiver to a
broadband router without a DHCP server function.
Before you set up the network, consult with your ISP or
the network manager for the required settings. It is
advised that you also refer to the operation manual
2
Select the DHCP setting you want.
When you select ON, the network is automatically set up,
and you do not need to follow Steps 3. Proceed with Step
4.
If there is no DHCP server on the network and you select
ON, this receiver will use its own Auto IP function to
determine the IP address.
2
3
Enter the IP Address
Gateway Primary DNS Server and Secondary DNS
Server
,
Subnet Mask, Default
1
supplied with your network component.
,
IP Address
.
The IP address to be entered must be defined within the
following ranges. If the IP address defined is beyond the
following ranges, you cannot listen to Internet radio
stations.
Class A: 10.0.0.1 to 10.255.255.254
Class B: 172.16.0.1 to 172.31.255.254
Class C: 192.168.0.1 to 192.168.255.254
Press / to select a number and / to move the
cursor.
4
Select ‘OFF’ or ‘ON’ for the Enable Proxy Server
setting to deactivate or activate the proxy server.
In case you select ‘OFF’, proceed with Step 7. In case you
select ‘ON’, on the other hand, proceed with Step 5.
Subnet Mask
5
Enter the address of your proxy server or the
In case an xDSL modem or a terminal adapter is directly
connected to this receiver, enter the subnet mask
provided by your ISP on paper. In most cases, enter
255.255.255.0.
domain name.
6
Enter the port number of your proxy server.
Use the numeric buttons to enter the port number.
7
Select ‘OK’ to confirm the IP Address/Proxy setup.
Default Gateway
In case a gateway (router) is connected to this receiver,
enter the corresponding IP address.
Checking the MAC address
You can check the MAC address.
Primary DNS Server/Secondary DNS Server
In case there is only one DNS server address provided by
your ISP on paper, enter it in the ‘Primary DNS Server’
field. In case there are more than two DNS server
addresses, enter ‘Secondary DNS Server’ in the other
DNS server address field.
1
Select ‘Information’ from the Network Setup
menu.
Network Standby
This setting allows the Web Control function (page 65)
for operating the receiver from a computer connected on
the same LAN as the receiver to be used even when the
receiver is in the standby mode.
Proxy Hostname/Proxy Port
This setting is required when you connect this receiver to
the Internet via a proxy server. Enter the IP address of
your proxy server in the ‘Proxy Hostname’ field. Also,
enter the port number of your proxy server in the ‘Proxy
Port’ field.
1
Select ‘Network Standby’ from the Network Setup
menu.
2
Specify whether the Network Standby is ON or OFF.
• ON – The Web Control function can be used even
Tip
when the receiver is in the standby mode.
• Press / or the numeric buttons to enter
alphanumeric characters. To delete alphanumeric
characters entered one at a time, press CLEAR.
• OFF – The Web Control function cannot be used
when the receiver is in the standby mode (This lets
you reduce power consumption in the standby
mode).
Note
1 In case you make changes to the network configuration without the DHCP server function, make the corresponding changes to the network
settings of this receiver.
2 The IP address determined by the Auto IP function is 169.254.X.X. You cannot listen to an Internet radio station if the IP address is set for the
Auto IP function.
88
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The System Setup and Other Setup menus
11
Volume Setup
You can set the maximum volume of this receiver or
specify what the volume level will be when the power is
turned on.
The Other Setup menu
The Other Setup menu is where you can make
customized settings to reflect how you are using the
receiver.
1
Select ‘Volume Setup’ from the Other Setup menu.
2
Select the Power ON Level setting you want.
RECEIVER
on the remote control, then press
1
Press
The volume can be set so that it is always set to the same
level when the receiver’s power is turned on.
HOME MENU
.
A Graphical User Interface (GUI) screen appears on your
TV. Use /// and ENTER to navigate through the
screens and select menu items. Press RETURN to
confirm and exit the current menu.
• LAST (default) – When the power is turned on, the
volume is set to the same level as when the power
was last turned off.
• “---” – When the power is turned on, the volume is set
to minimum level.
2
3
4
Select ‘System Setup’ from the Home Menu.
Select ‘Other Setup’, then press ENTER
.
• –80.0dB to +12.0dB – Specify the volume to be set
when the power is turned on, in steps of 0.5 dB.
Select the setting you want to adjust.
If you are doing this for the first time, you may want to
adjust these settings in order:
It is not possible to set a volume level greater than the
value specified at Volume Limit setup (see below).
• HDMI Setup – Synchronizes this receiver with your
Pioneer component supporting Control with HDMI
(page 57).
3
Select the Volume Limit setting you want.
Use this function to limit the maximum volume. The
volume cannot be increased above the level set here,
even by operating MASTER VOLUME button (or the dial
on the front panel).
• Volume Setup – Sets up the volume-related
operations of this receiver (see below)
.
• Remote Control Mode Setup – Sets this receiver’s
remote control mode (see below).
• OFF (default) – The maximum volume is not limited.
• –20.0dB/–10.0dB/0.0dB – The maximum volume is
limited to the value set here.
• Flicker Reduction – Adjusts the way the GUI screen
looks (page 90).
4
Select the Mute Level setting you want.
• EXTENSION Setup – Allows the CU-RF100 to be used
even when the receiver is in the standby mode
(page 90).
This sets how much the volume is to be turned down
when MUTE is pressed.
• FULL (default) – No sound.
• Multi Ch In Setup – Specifies the optional settings for
a multi-channel input (page 90).
• –40.0dB/–20.0dB – The volume will be turned down
to the level specified here.
• Pairing Bluetooth Setup – Use to pair a Bluetooth
ADAPTER and Bluetooth wireless technology device
(page 51).
5
When you’re finished, press RETURN.
You will return to the Other Setup menu.
5
Make the adjustments necessary for each setting,
Remote Control Mode Setup
• Default setting: 1
pressing RETURN to confirm after each screen.
This sets this receiver’s remote control mode to prevent
erroneous operation when multiple units of the receiver
are being used.
1
Select ‘Remote Control Mode Setup’ from the
Other Setup menu.
2
3
4
Select the Remote Control Mode setting you want.
Select “OK” to change the remote control mode.
Follow the instructions on the screen to change the
remote control’s setting.
See Operating multiple receivers on page 67.
5
When you’re finished, press RETURN
.
You will return to the Other Setup menu.
89
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The System Setup and Other Setup menus
11
Flicker Reduction Setup
• Default setting: OFF
The GUI screen’s resolution can be increased. If you feel
the GUI screen is hard to see, try changing this setting.
Note that the resolution in this setting only affects the
GUI screen; it has no influence on the video output.
1
Select ‘Flicker Reduction Setup’ from the Other
Setup menu.
2
3
Select the Flicker Reduction setting you want.
When you’re finished, press RETURN
.
You will return to the Other Setup menu.
EXTENSION Setup
• Default setting: OFF
The CU-RF100 can be used to operate the receiver by RF
communications. To do so, set the EXTENSION setting to
ON. When ON is set here, the receiver can be operated
even when the receiver is in the standby mode.
1
Select ‘EXTENSION Setup’ from the Other Setup
menu.
2
3
Select the EXTENSION setting you want.
When you’re finished, press RETURN
.
You will return to the Other Setup menu.
Multi Channel Input Setup
You can adjust the level of the subwoofer for a multi-
channel input. Also, when the multi-channel input is
selected as an input function, you can display the video
images of other input functions. In the Multi Channel
Input Setup, you can assign a video input to the multi-
channel input.
1
Select ‘Multi Ch In Setup’ from the Other Setup
menu.
2
Select the ‘SW Input Gain’ setting you want.
• 0dB – Outputs sound of the subwoofer at the level
originally recorded on the source.
• +10dB – Outputs sound of the subwoofer at the level
increased by 10 dB.
3
Select the ‘Video Input’ setting you want.
When the multi-channel input is selected as an input
function, you can display the video images of other input
functions. The video input can be selected from the
following: DVD, TV/SAT, DVR/BDR, VIDEO, OFF.
4
When you’re finished, press RETURN
.
You will return to the Other Setup menu.
90
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Chapter 12:
Additional information
Step 3: Adjusting the speaker orientation
If the left and right speakers are not pointing in the same
direction, the tone will not be the same on the right and
left, and as a result the sound field will not be reproduced
properly. However, if all the speakers are pointed towards
the listening position, the sound field will seem cramped.
Testing by the Pioneer Multi-channel Research Group
has shown that a good sense of sound positioning can be
achieved by pointing all the speakers towards an area
30 cm to 80 cm (12 inches to 31 inches) behind the
listening position (between the surround speakers and
the listening position).
Speaker Setting Guide
In order to achieve an even better surround effect, it is
important to accurately position the speakers and make
their volume and tone characteristics uniform so as to
finely focus the multi-channel sound.
The three major elements in positioning the speakers are
distance, angle and orientation (the direction in which
the speakers are pointing).
Distance: The distance of all the speakers should be
equal.
However, the sense of sound positioning can differ
according to the conditions in the room and the speakers
being used. In smaller environments in particular (when
the front speakers are close to the listening position),
with this method the speakers will be pointed too inward.
We suggest you use this example of installation as
reference when trying out different installation methods.
Angle: The speakers should be horizontally symmetrical.
Orientation: The orientation should be horizontally
symmetrical.
In most homes, however, it is not possible to achieve this
environment. For the distance, on this receiver it is
possible to automatically correct the speaker distance
1
electrically to a precision of /2 inch using the Full Auto
Step 4: Positioning and adjusting the subwoofer
Placing the subwoofer between the center and front
speakers makes even music sources sound more natural
(if there is only one subwoofer, it doesn’t matter if it is
placed on the left or right side). The low bass sound
output from the subwoofer is not directional and there is
no need to adjust the height. Normally the subwoofer is
placed on the floor. Put it in a position at which it will not
cancel out the bass sound output from the other
speakers. Also note that placing it near a wall may result
in sympathetic vibrations with the building that could
excessively amplify the bass sound.
MCACC Setup function (page 38).
Step 1: Speaker layout and distance adjustment
Use speaker stands or the like to make sure the speakers
are steady, and leave at least 10 cm (4 inches) from the
surrounding walls. Position the speakers attentively so
that the speakers on the left and right are at equal angles
from the listening position (center of the adjustments).
(We recommend using cords, etc., when adjusting the
layout.) Ideally all the speakers should be equidistant
from the listening position.
If the subwoofer must be installed near a wall, place it at
an angle so that it is not parallel to the wall surface. This
can help reduce any sympathetic vibrations, but
depending on the shape of the room this could result in
standing waves. However, even if standing waves are
generated, their influence on the sound quality can be
prevented using the Auto MCACC’s standing wave
control function (page 81).
Tip
• If the speakers cannot be set at equal distances (on a
circle), use the Auto MCACC Setup speaker distance
correction and Fine Speaker Distance functions to
make them equalize the distance artificially.
Step 2: Adjusting the speaker height
Adjust the heights (angles) of the different speakers.
Adjust so that the front speaker units reproducing mid-
and high frequencies is roughly at the height of the ears.
Step 5: Default settings with the Auto MCACC
Setup (auto sound field correction) function
It is more effective to perform the Full Auto MCACC Setup
(page 38) procedure once the adjustments described
above have been completed.
If the center speaker cannot be set at the same height as
the front speakers, adjust its angle of elevation to point it
to the listening position.
Set surround speaker 1 so that it is not under the height
of the ears.
Tip
• The distance to the subwoofer may be slightly larger
than the distance actually measured with a tape
measure, etc. This is because this distance is
corrected for electric delay, and is not a problem.
91
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Position of center speaker and monitor
Positional relationship between speakers
and monitor
Since mostly dialogs are output from the center speaker,
keeping the center speaker as close as possible to the
screen makes the overall sound more natural. For TVs
using Braun tubes, however, when installing the center
speaker on the floor, adjust its angle of elevation to point
it towards the listening position.
Position of front speakers and monitor
The front speakers should be as equidistant as possible
to the monitor.
Installation on floor
(Diagram as seen
from the side)
TV
L
R
Monitor
45° to 60°
• If the center speaker is not of the shielded type, install
it away from the TV.
• When installing the center speaker on top of the
monitor, place it facing slightly downwards towards
the listening position.
Troubleshooting
Incorrect operations are often mistaken for trouble and malfunctions. If you think that there is something wrong with
this component, check the points below. Sometimes the trouble may lie in another component. Investigate the other
components and electrical appliances being used. If the trouble cannot be rectified even after exercising the checks
listed below, ask your nearest Pioneer authorized independent service company to carry out repair work.
Note
• If the unit does not operate normally due to external effects such as static electricity disconnect the power plug
from the outlet and insert again to return to normal operating conditions.
Power
Symptom
Remedy
The power does not turn on.
• Make sure that the power cord is plugged in to an active power outlet.
• Try disconnecting from the power outlet, then plugging back in.
Power cannot be turned off.
• Press the remote control’s ZONE 2 or ZONE 3, then press RECEIVER to switch the sub zone off.
(ZONE 2 ON or ZONE 3 ON is
displayed.)
The receiver suddenly switches • Check that there are no loose strands of speaker wire touching the rear panel or another set of
off or the iPod iPhone
wires. If so, re-attach the speaker wires, making sure there are no stray strands.
indicator blinks.
• The receiver may have a serious problem. Disconnect from the power and call a Pioneer authorized
independent service company.
During loud playback the
• Turn down the volume.
power suddenly switches off.
• Lower the 63 Hz and 125 Hz equalizer levels in the Manual MCACC setup on page 77.
• Switch on the digital safety feature. While holding down ENTER on the front panel, press
STANDBY/ON to set this receiver to the standby mode. Use TUNE / to select D.SAFETY
OFF, and then use PRESET / to select 1 or 2 (select D.SAFETY OFF to deactivate this
feature). If the power switches off even with 2 switched on, turn down the volume. With 1 or 2 on,
some features may be unavailable.
The unit does not respond
• Try switching the receiver off, then back on again.
when the buttons are pressed.
• Try disconnecting the power cord, then connect again.
92
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Symptom
Remedy
AMP ERR blinks in the display, • The receiver may have a serious problem. Do not try switching the receiver on. Unplug the receiver
then the power automatically from the wall and call a Pioneer authorized independent service company.
switches off. The ADVANCED
MCACC blinks and the power
does not turn on.
The PQLS flashes and power
turns off.
• There is a problem with the receiver’s power unit or fan. Try turning on the power after 1 minute. If
the same thing happens, the receiver is damaged. Unplug the receiver from the wall and call a
Pioneer authorized independent service company. (Other symptoms may appear when the power is
turned on.)
OVERHEAT blinks in the
display or AMP OVERHEAT
and the indicator at the center
of the receiver flash and the
power turns off.
• Allow the unit to cool down in a well-ventilated place before switching back on.
• Wait at least 1 minute, then try turning the power on again.
The receiver suddenly power
off or ADVANCED MCACC
flashes.
• The power unit is damaged. Unplug the receiver from the wall and call a Pioneer authorized
independent service company.
Display blinks 12V TRG ERR. • An error has arisen in the 12 V trigger jacks. Reconnect accurately then turn the power back on.
No sound
Symptom
Remedy
No sound is output when an
input function is selected.
• Check the volume, mute setting (press MUTE) and speaker setting (press SPEAKERS).
• Make sure the correct input function is selected.
No sound is output from the
front speakers.
• Check that the MCACC setup microphone is disconnected.
• Make sure the correct input signal is selected (press SIGNAL SEL). Note that when PCM is
selected, you won’t be able to hear any other signal format.
• Check that the source component is connected properly (see Connecting your equipment on
page 16).
• Check that the speakers are connected properly (see Connecting the speakers on page 19).
No sound from the surround or • Check that the Stereo listening mode or the Front Stage Surround Advance mode isn’t selected;
center speakers.
select one of the surround listening modes (see Listening in surround sound on page 53).
• Check that the surround/center speakers are not set to NO (see Speaker Setting on page 85).
• Check the channel level settings (see Channel Level on page 86).
• Check the speaker connections (see Connecting the speakers on page 19).
No sound from surround back • Check that the surround back speakers are set to LARGE or SMALL, and the surround speakers
speakers.
are not set to NO (see Speaker Setting on page 85).
• Check the speaker connections (see Connecting the speakers on page 19). If only one surround
back speaker is connected, make sure it’s connected to the left channel speaker terminal.
• Surround back speakers will not play while the Speaker System is set to Speaker B and audio is
being played through speaker B.
No sound from front height or • Check that the front height or front wide speakers are set to LARGE or SMALL, and the surround
front wide speakers.
speakers are not set to NO (see Speaker Setting on page 85).
• Check the speaker connections (see Connecting the speakers on page 19).
No sound from subwoofer.
• Check that the subwoofer is connected properly, switched on and the volume turned up.
• If your subwoofer has a sleep function, make sure it is switched off.
• Make sure that the Subwoofer setting is YES or PLUS (see Speaker Setting on page 85).
• The crossover frequency may be set too low; try setting it higher to match the characteristics of
your other speakers (see Speaker Setting on page 85).
• If there is very little low frequency information in the source material, change your speaker settings
to Front: SMALL / Subwoofer: YES, or Front: LARGE / Subwoofer: PLUS (see Speaker Setting on
page 85).
• Check that the LFE channel is not set to OFF, or to a very quiet setting (see Setting the Audio options
on page 60).
• Check the speaker level settings (see Channel Level on page 86).
93
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Symptom
Remedy
No sound from one speaker.
• Check the speaker connection (see Connecting the speakers on page 19).
• Check the speaker level settings (see Channel Level on page 86).
• Check that the speaker hasn’t been set to NO (see Speaker Setting on page 85).
• The channel may not be recorded in the source. By using one of the advanced effect listening
modes, you may be able to create the missing channel (see Listening in surround sound on page 53).
Sound is produced from
analog components, but not
from digital ones (DVD, LD,
CD-ROM, etc.).
• Check that the input signal type is set to DIGITAL (see Choosing the input signal on page 56).
• Make sure that the digital input is assigned correctly for the input jack the component is connected
to (see The Input Setup menu on page 40).
• Check the digital output settings on the source component.
• If the source component has a digital volume control, make sure this is not turned down.
• Make sure that the multichannel analog inputs are not selected. Select any other input function.
No sound is output or a noise is • Check that your DVD player is compatible with Dolby Digital/DTS discs.
output when Dolby Digital/DTS
software is played back.
• Check the digital output settings of your DVD player. Make sure that the DTS signal output is set
to On.
• If the source component has a digital volume control, make sure this is not turned down.
No sound when using the
• If the HDMI input function is selected, sound is muted until exiting the Home Menu.
Home Menu.
Other audio problems
Symptom
Remedy
Broadcast stations cannot be For FM broadcasts
selected automatically, or
there is considerable noise in
radio broadcasts.
• Fully extend the FM wire antenna, adjust the position for best reception and secure to a wall, etc.
• Use an outdoor antenna for better reception (see page 32).
For AM broadcasts
• Adjust the position and direction of the AM antenna.
• Use an outdoor antenna for better reception (see page 32).
• Noise may be caused by interference from other equipment, such as a fluorescent light, motor,
etc. Switch off or move the other equipment, or move the AM antenna.
Noise is output when scanning • This is not a malfunction of the receiver. The scan function of your player alters the digital
a DTS CD.
information, making it unreadable, resulting in noise being output. Lower the volume when
scanning.
When playing a DTS format LD • Make sure that the input signal type is set to DIGITAL (see Choosing the input signal on page 56).
there is audible noise on the
soundtrack.
Can’t record audio.
• You can only make a digital recording from a digital source, and an analog recording from an
analog source.
• For digital sources, make sure that what you’re recording isn’t copy protected.
• Check that the OUT jacks are properly connected to the recorders input jacks (see Connecting the
multichannel analog inputs on page 29).
Subwoofer output is very low. • To route more signal to the subwoofer, set it to PLUS or set the front speakers to SMALL (see
Speaker Setting on page 85).
Everything seems to be set up • The speakers may be out of phase. Check that the positive/negative speaker terminals on the
correctly, but the playback
sound is odd.
receiver are matched with the corresponding terminals on the speakers (see Connecting the
speakers on page 19).
The PHASE CONTROL feature • If applicable, check that the lowpass filter switch on your subwoofer is off, or the lowpass cutoff is
doesn’t seem to have an
audible effect.
set to the highest frequency setting. If there is a PHASE setting on your subwoofer, set it to 0º (or
depending on the subwoofer, the setting where you think it has the best overall effect on the sound).
• Make sure the speaker distance setting is correct for all speakers (see Speaker Distance on
page 86).
Noise or hum can be heard
even when there is no sound
being input.
• Check that personal computers or other digital components connected to the same power source
are not causing interference.
94
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Symptom
Remedy
Can’t select some Input
functions by the INPUT
SELECTOR on the front panel
or the INPUT SELECT button on
the remote control.
• Check the Input Skip settings in the Input Setup menu.
• Check the HDMI Input assignment in the Input Setup menu then try OFF.
There seems to be a time lag • See Automatically conducting optimum sound tuning (Full Auto MCACC) on page 38 to set up your
between the speakers and the system again using MCACC (this will automatically compensate for a delay in the subwoofer output).
output of the subwoofer.
Speaker switching sound
• Depending on the listening mode, the front height (or front wide) and surround back speakers may
(clicking sound) is heard from switch automatically in function of changes in the input audio. A speaker switching sound (clicking
receiver during playback.
sound) will be heard from the receiver at this time. If this sound bothers you, we recommend
changing the listening mode (see Listening in surround sound on page 53).
The maximum volume
• Check that the Volume Limit is set to OFF (see Volume Setup on page 89).
available (shown in the front
panel display) is lower than the
+12dB maximum.
• The channel level setting may be over 0dB.
ADAPTER PORT
Symptom
Remedy
The Bluetooth wireless
technology device cannot be
connected or operated.
Sound from the Bluetooth
wireless technology device is
not emitted or the sound is
interrupted.
• Check that no object that emits electromagnetic waves in the 2.4 GHz band (microwave
oven, wireless LAN device or Bluetooth wireless technology apparatus) is near the unit. If
such an object is near the unit, set the unit far from it. Or, stop using the object emitting the
electromagnetic waves.
• Check that the Bluetooth wireless technology device is not too far from the unit and that
obstructions are not set between the Bluetooth wireless technology device and the unit. Set
the Bluetooth wireless technology device and the unit so that the distance between them is
less than about 10 m and no obstructions exist between them.
• Check that the Bluetooth ADAPTER and the ADAPTER PORT of the unit are correctly connected.
• The Bluetooth wireless technology device may not be set to the communication mode
supporting the Bluetooth wireless technology. Check the setting of the Bluetooth wireless
technology device.
• Check that pairing is correct. The pairing setting was deleted from this unit or the Bluetooth
wireless technology device. Reset the pairing.
• Check that the profile is correct. Use a Bluetooth wireless technology device that supports
A2DP profile and AVRCP profile.
Video
Symptom
Remedy
No image is output when an
• Check the video connections of the source component (see page 27).
input is selected.
• For HDMI, or when digital video conversion is set to OFF and a TV and another component are
connected with different cords (in Setting the Video options on page 62), you must connect your TV
to this receiver using the same type of video cable as you used to connect your video component.
• Make sure the input assignment is correct for components connected using component video or
HDMI cables (see The Input Setup menu on page 40).
• Check the video output settings of the source component.
• Check that the video input you selected on your TV is correct.
• Some components (such as video game units) have resolutions that may not be converted. If
adjusting this receiver’s Resolution setting (in Setting the Video options on page 62) and/or the
resolution settings on your component or display doesn’t work, try switching Digital Video
Conversion (in Setting the Video options on page 62) to OFF.
Can’t record video.
• Check that the source is not copy-protected.
• The video converter is not available when making recordings. Check that the same type of video
cable is used for connecting both the recorder and the video source (the one you want to record) to
this receiver.
95
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Symptom
Remedy
Noisy, intermittent, or distorted • Sometimes a video deck may output a noisy video signal (during scanning, for example), or the video
picture.
quality may just be poor (with some video game units, for example). The picture quality may also depend
on the settings, etc. of your display device. Switch off the video converter and reconnect the source and
display device using the same type of connection (component or composite), then start playback again.
Video signals are not output
• When a monitor only compatible with resolutions of 480i is connected to the component terminal
from the component terminal. and another monitor is connected to the HDMI terminal, the video signals may not be output to the
monitor connected to the component terminal. If this happens, do the following:
– Turn off the power of the monitor connected to the HDMI terminal.
– Change the VIDEO PARAMETER menu RES setting.
– Video signals from the HDMI terminal cannot be output to the component terminals. Input the
video signals from the player or other source to the composite or component terminals. When using
the component terminal, assign it at Input Setup.
The picture’s movement is
unnatural.
• When Resolution under VIDEO PARAMETER is set to 1080/24p, the picture may not be displayed
properly for some source materials. In this case, set the resolution to something other than 1080/24p
(page 62).
Settings
Symptom
Remedy
The Auto MCACC Setup
continually shows an error.
• The ambient noise level may be too high. Keep the noise level in the room as low as possible (see
also Problems when using the Auto MCACC Setup on page 40). If the noise level cannot be kept low
enough, you will have to set up the surround sound manually (page 84).
• When using only one surround back speaker, connect it to the SURROUND BACK L (Single) terminals.
• To use a 5.1-channel speaker set, use the surround speakers for the surround channel, not the
surround back channel.
• Make sure there are no obstacles between the speakers and the microphone.
• If Reverse Phase is displayed, try the following:
– The speaker’s wiring (+ and –) may be inverted. Check the speaker connections.
–
Depending on the type of speakers and their installation conditions, Reverse Phase may be
displayed even if the speakers are properly connected. If this happens, select GO NEXT and continue.
– If the speaker is not pointed to the microphone (listening position) or when using speakers that
affect the phase (dipole speakers, reflective speakers, etc.), it may not be possible to properly identify
the polarity.
After using the Auto MCACC • There may have been some low frequency noise in the room from an air-conditioner, motor, etc.
Setup, the speaker size setting Switch off all other appliances in the room and use Auto MCACC Setup again.
is incorrect.
• Depending on a number of factors (bass reproduction capabilities of the speakers, room size,
speaker placement, etc.) this may occur in some cases. Change the speaker setting manually in
Speaker Setting on page 85, and use the ALL (Keep SP System) option for the Auto MCACC menu
in Automatic MCACC (Expert) on page 75 if this is a recurring problem.
Can’t adjust the Fine Speaker • Check that the speakers are all in phase (make sure the positive (+) and negative (–) terminals are
Distance setting (page 78)
matched up properly).
properly.
The display shows KEY LOCK ON • With the receiver in standby, press STANDBY/ON for about 10 seconds while holding down
when you try to make settings. SPEAKERS to disable the key lock.
Most recent settings have been • The power cord was disconnected from the wall while adjusting this setting.
erased.
• Settings are only stored if all the zones are turned off. Turn off all the zones before unplugging the
power cord.
The various system settings are • Make sure the blue STANDBY/ON light has gone out before unplugging.
not stored.
Professional Calibration EQ graphical output
Symptom
Remedy
The EQ response displayed in • There are cases where the graph does not appear flat (even when selecting ALL CH ADJ in the Auto
the graphical output following MCACC Setup) due to adjustments made to compensate for room characteristics to achieve optimal
calibration does not appear
sound.
entirely flat.
• Areas of the graph may appear identical (before and after) when there is little or no adjustment
needed.
• The graph may appear to have shifted vertically when comparing before and after measurements.
96
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Symptom
Remedy
EQ adjustments made using
• Despite level adjustments being made, the filters used for analysis may not display these
the Manual MCACC setup on adjustments in the graphical output. However, these adjustments are taken into account by the
page 77 do not appear to
filters dedicated to overall system calibration.
change the graphical output.
Lower frequency response
curves do not seem to have
been calibrated for SMALL
speakers.
• Low frequencies used in bass management (the subwoofer channel) will not change for speakers
that have been specified as SMALL in the configuration, or do not output these frequencies.
• Calibration is performed, but due to your speakers’ low frequency limitations, no measurable
sound is output for display.
Display
Symptom
Remedy
The display is dark or off.
• Press DIMMER repeatedly to select a different brightness.
You can’t get DIGITAL to
display when using SIGNAL
SEL.
• Check the digital connections and make sure that the digital inputs are assigned correctly (see The
Input Setup menu on page 40).
• If the multichannel analog inputs are selected, select a different input function.
2 DIGITAL or DTS does not • These indicators do not light if playback is paused.
light when playing Dolby/DTS
software.
• Check the playback (especially the digital output) settings of the source component.
When playing Dolby Digital or • Check that the player is connected using a digital connection.
DTS sources, the receiver’s
format indicators do not light.
• Make sure that the receiver is set to AUTO or DIGITAL (see Choosing the input signal on page 56).
• Check that the player isn’t set up so that Dolby Digital and DTS sources are converted to PCM.
• Ensure that if there are several audio tracks on the disc, the Dolby Digital or DTS is selected.
When playing certain discs,
none of the receiver’s format
indicators light.
• The disc may not contain 5.1/6.1 channel material. Check the disc packaging for more on what
audio tracks are recorded on the disc.
When playing a disc with the • Make sure that the receiver is set to AUTO or DIGITAL (see Choosing the input signal on page 56).
listening mode set to Auto
Surround or ALC, 2 PL II or
Neo:6 appear on the receiver.
• If a two channel soundtrack is currently playing (including Dolby Surround encoded), then this is
not a malfunction. Check the disc packaging for details about the audio tracks available.
During playback of DVD-Audio, • This will occur when playing DVD-Audio material over the HDMI connection. This is not a
the display shows PCM.
malfunction.
The power turns off
• See the Power section (page 92).
automatically and some
indicator flashes, or some
indicator flashes and the power
does not turn on.
Remote control
Symptom
Remedy
Cannot be remote controlled. • Set the remote control unit’s remote control mode so that it matches the setting on the main unit
(see Operating multiple receivers on page 67).
• Check whether the receiver’s remote control mode is properly set (see Remote Control Mode Setup
on page 89).
• Try replacing the batteries in the remote control (see Loading the batteries on page 10).
• Be sure to operate within 7 m (23 feet) and a 30º angle of the remote sensor on the front panel (see
Operating range of remote control unit on page 10).
• Check that there are no obstacles between the receiver and the remote control.
• Make sure that there is no fluorescent or other strong light shining on to the remote sensor.
• Check the connections of the CONTROL IN jacks (see Operating other Pioneer components with
this unit’s sensor on page 36).
Other components can’t be
operated with the system
remote.
• If the battery ran down, the preset codes may have been cleared. Re-enter the preset codes.
• The preset code may be incorrect. Redo the procedure for entering preset codes.
• When commands from the remote control units of other devices are registered using the learning
function, in some cases they may not be learned properly. In this case, register the commands again
using the learning function (see Programming signals from other remote controls on page 68). If they
still do not work, they may be in a special format that cannot be registered on this receiver’s remote
control. Operate the device using another remote control.
97
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Web Control
Symptoms
Causes
Remedies
Top Menu screen is not
displayed on browser.
This receiver’s IP address has not been entered Check the receiver’s IP address and enter it
correctly in the browser (page 87).
into the browser correctly.
Receiver cannot be operated JavaScript is disabled on the internet browser.
Enable JavaScript.
from browser.
The browser is not compatible with JavaScript.
Use an internet browser that is compatible with
JavaScript.
Receiver’s power does not
turn on when the power is
turned on using the Web
Control function.
Network Standby at Network Setup is set to
OFF.
Set Network Standby at Network Setup to ON
(page 88).
HDMI
Symptom
Remedy
The HDMI indicator blinks
• Check all the points below.
continuously.
No picture or sound.
• This receiver is HDCP-compatible. Check that the components you are connecting are also HDCP-
compatible. If they are not, please connect them using the component or composite video jacks.
• Depending on the connected source component, it’s possible that it will not work with this receiver
(even if it is HDCP-compatible). In this case, connect using the component or composite video jacks
between source and receiver.
• If the problem still persists when connecting your HDMI component directly to your monitor,
please consult the component or monitor manual or contact the manufacturer for support.
• If video images do not appear on your TV, try adjusting the resolution, Deep Color or other setting
for your component.
• While analog video signals are being output over HDMI, use a separate connection for audio
output.
®
• To output signals in Deep Color, use an HDMI cable (High Speed HDMI Cable) to connect this
receiver to a component or TV with the Deep Color feature.
No picture.
• Try changing the Resolution setting (in Setting the Video options on page 62).
• Set the HDMI output setting to the connected HDMI OUT terminal (in Switching the HDMI output
on page 65).
No sound, or sound suddenly • Check that the HDMI AV setting is set to AMP/THROUGH.
ceases.
• If the component is a DVI device, use a separate connection for the audio.
• If analog video is being output over HDMI, please use a separate connection for the audio.
• Check the audio output settings of the source component.
• HDMI format digital audio transmissions require a longer time to be recognized. Due to this,
interruption in the audio may occur when switching between audio formats or beginning playback.
• Turning on/off the device connected to this unit's HDMI OUT terminal during playback, or
disconnecting/connecting the HDMI cable during playback, may cause noise or interrupted audio.
Noisy or distorted picture.
• Sometimes a video deck may output a noisy video signal (during scanning, for example), or the
video quality may just be poor (with some video game units, for example). The picture quality may
also depend on the settings, etc. of your display device. Switch off the video converter and reconnect
the source and display device using the same type of connection (component or composite), then
start playback again.
• If the problem still persists when connecting your HDMI component directly to your monitor,
please consult the component or monitor manual or contact the manufacturer for support.
HDCP ERROR shows in the
display.
• Check whether or not the connected component is compatible with HDCP. If it is not compatible
with HDCP, reconnect the source device using a different type of connection (component or
composite). Some components that are compatible with HDCP still cause this message to be
displayed, but so long as there is no problem with displaying video, this is not a malfunction.
When Control with HDMI is
set to ON, the HDMI Input
assignment at Input Setup is
canceled.
• Even when Control with HDMI is set to ON, for Digital In assignment of HDMI 1 is not canceled,
so in this case use the HDMI 1 input.
98
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Symptom
Remedy
Synchronized operation not
possible using Control with
HDMI function.
• Check the HDMI connections.
• The cable may be damaged.
• Select ON for the Control with HDMI setting (see HDMI Setup on page 57).
• Select ALL for the Control Mode with HDMI setting (see HDMI Setup on page 57).
• Turn the TV’s power on before turning on this receiver’s power.
• Set the TV side Control with HDMI setting to on (see TV’s operating instructions).
• Connect the TV to the HDMI OUT 1 terminal and set the HDMI output to HDMI OUT 1. Then turn
on first the TV’s power, then this receiver’s power.
Important information regarding the HDMI connection
There are cases where you may not be able to route HDMI signals through this receiver (this depends on the HDMI-
equipped component you are connecting–check with the manufacturer for HDMI compatibility information).
If you aren’t receiving HDMI signals properly through this receiver (from your component), please try one of the
following configurations when connecting up.
Configuration A
Configuration B
Use component video cables to connect the video output
of your HDMI-equipped component to the receiver’s
component video input. The receiver can then convert the
analog component video signal to a digital HDMI signal
for transmission to the display. For this configuration,
use the most convenient connection (digital is
recommended) for sending audio to the receiver. See the
operating instructions for more on audio connections.
Connect your HDMI-equipped component directly to the
display using an HDMI cable. Then use the most
convenient connection (digital is recommended) for
sending audio to the receiver. See the operating
instructions for more on audio connections. Set the display
volume to minimum when using this configuration.
Note
• If your display only has one HDMI terminal, you can
only receive HDMI video from the connected
component.
Note
• The picture quality will change slightly during
conversion.
• Depending on the component, audio output may be
limited to the number of channels available from the
connected display unit (for example audio output is
reduced to 2 channels for a monitor with stereo audio
limitations).
• If you want to switch the input function, you’ll have to
switch functions on both the receiver and your
display unit.
• Since the sound is muted on the display when using
the HDMI connection, you must adjust the volume on
the display every time you switch input functions.
USB interface
Symptoms
Causes
Remedies
The folders/files stored on a
The folders/files are currently stored in a region Store the folders/files in the FAT region.
USB memory device are not other than the FAT (File Allocation Table) region.
displayed.
The number of levels in a folder is more than 8.
Limit the maximum number of levels in a folder to
8 (page 44).
There are more than 30 000 folders/files stored in Limit the maximum number of folders/files stored
a USB memory device.
in a USB memory device to 30 000 (page 44).
The audio files are copyrighted.
Copyrighted audio files stored on a USB memory
device cannot be played back (page 44).
99
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Symptoms
Causes
Remedies
A USB memory device is not The USB memory device does not support the
Try using a USB memory device compatible with
the mass storage class specifications. Note that
there are cases where even the audio files stored
on a USB memory device compatible with the
mass storage class specifications are not played
back on this receiver (page 44).
recognized.
mass storage class specifications.
Connect the USB memory device and switch on
this receiver (page 35).
A USB hub is currently being used.
This receiver does not support USB hubs
(page 44).
This receiver recognizes the USB memory device Switch off and on again this receiver.
as a fraud.
A USB memory device is
Some formats of USB memory devices, including Check whether the format of your USB memory
connected and displayed, but FAT 12, NTFS, and HFS, cannot be played back on device is either FAT 16 or FAT 32. Note that the FAT
the audio files stored on the
USB memory device cannot
be played back.
this receiver.
12, NTFS, and HFS formats cannot be played back
on this receiver (page 44).
The file format cannot be properly played back on See the list of file formats that can be played back
this receiver. on this receiver (page 45).
Cannot detect USB keyboard. The USB keyboard is routed through a USB hub. This receiver is not compatible with USB hubs.
Plug the keyboard directly into the receiver.
A PS2 keyboard is routed through a PS2/USB
connector.
PS2 keyboards cannot be used with this receiver,
even if routed through a PS2/USB connector. Use
a USB keyboard.
Keyboard is not a USB HID Class device.
Some devices will not be detected. Use a USB HID
Class keyboard.
Cannot enter correct text
using the USB keyboard.
Keyboard is not US-international layout keyboard. Use a US-international layout keyboard. NB:
Some characters cannot be entered.
Internet radio
Symptoms
Causes
Remedies
Cannot access the network.
(“Connection Error” shows in
the display.)
The LAN cable is not firmly connected.
The router is not switched on.
Firmly connect the LAN cable (page 33).
Switch on the router.
The network device was switched on when this
Switch the network device on before the receiver.
receiver was already on.
Cannot listen to Internet radio The firewall settings for components on the
Check the firewall settings for components on the
network.
stations.
network are currently in operation.
(“Connection Error” shows in
the display.)
You are currently disconnected from the Internet. Check the connection settings for components on
the network, and consult with your network
service provider if necessary (page 87).
The URL for the Internet radio station is
incorrectly programmed.
Check that the URL was correctly entered when
programming.
The broadcasts from an Internet radio station are Broadcasts may be interrupted or suspended by
the radio station.
stopped or interrupted.
An Internet radio station is selected whose
protocol this receiver does not recognize.
This receiver does not recognize protocols other
than ‘http’ and ‘mms’.
An Internet radio station had closed or moved.
Enter new internet radio station on the Internet
Radio Setup.
Cannot listen to Internet radio Broadcast is in a format not compatible with this This receiver cannot play audio in formats other
stations. (“File Format Error” receiver.
shows in the display.)
than MP3 or WMA. Also, even if they are MP3 or
WMA formats, this receiver may not be able to
play back.
100
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Symptoms
Causes
Remedies
The Internet radio settings
screen cannot be displayed on into the browser correctly.
This receiver’s IP address has not been entered Check the receiver’s IP address and enter it
correctly on the browser (page 87).
the computer Internet
browser.
JavaScript is disabled on the Internet browser.
The browser is not compatible with JavaScript.
Enable JavaScript.
Use an Internet browser that is compatible with
JavaScript.
XM radio messages
Status messages
Check XM Tuner
Cause
Action
The XM Mini-Tuner is not installed or not fully seated Confirm the XM Mini-Tuner is fully seated in the dock
in the XM Mini-Tuner Home Dock or the XM Mini-
Tuner Dock is not connected to this receiver.
and check the XM Mini-Tuner Home Dock cable is
connected to this receiver.
Check Antenna
Loading
The XM antenna is not connected to the XM Mini-
Tuner Home Dock or the XM antenna cable is
damaged.
Check that the XM antenna is securely connected to
the XM Mini-Tuner Home Dock and check the
antenna cable for damage. Replace the XM antenna
if the cable is damaged.
The XM Mini-Tuner is acquiring audio or program
information from the XM satellite signal. This
message can also occur in weak XM signal
conditions.
This message should disappear in a few seconds in
good signal conditions.
If you see this message often, reposition the XM
antenna for better signal reception.
Note that this receiver may not respond to some
buttons while this message is displayed.
Use the Antenna Aiming option to optimize the
antenna position.
No Signal
The XM Mini-Tuner is not receiving the XM satellite Check for antenna obstructions and reposition the
signal. Something may be blocking the XM XM antenna to get better signal reception. Use the
antenna’s view of the satellites or the antenna is not Antenna Aiming option to optimize the antenna
properly aimed.
position.
See instructions supplied with the XM Mini-Tuner
and Home Dock for antenna installation
information.
Off Air
The XM channel you selected is not currently
Check back later.
broadcasting.
CH Unauthorized
You selected an XM channel that is blocked or
cannot be received with your XM subscription
package.
Consult the latest channel guide at
www.xmradio.com for the current list of channels.
For information on receiving this channel, visit
www.xmradio.com or contact XM Satellite Radio at
1-800-967-2346.
CH Unavailable
The selected channel is not available. The channel Consult the latest channel guide at
may have been reassigned to a different channel
number.
www.xmradio.com for the current list of channels.
For cases of a new radio or a radio that has not
received XM’s signal for an extended period, allow
the radio to receive the XM satellite signal for at least
5 minutes and then try to select the channel again.
This message may occur initially with a new radio or
a radio that has not received XM’s signal for an
extended period.
– – – – – – – –
No artist name or song title is available for this
No action required.
selection.
101
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Status messages
Cause
Action
Upgrade XM Tuner
The connected XM CNP-1000 is incompatible. This Contact XM Listener Care (1-800-967-2346) and ask
receiver features advanced technology that is
designed for use with the XM Mini-Tuner.
about upgrading your XM CNP-1000 to an XM Mini-
Tuner.
Have this receiver’s model name and CNP-1000 XM
Radio ID number ready beforehand, and explain that
this receiver is displaying the message Upgrade XM
Tuner.
If you already have an XM Mini-Tuner connected and
you see this message, turn off this receiver, make
sure the XM Mini-Tuner is properly seated in the
Mini-Tuner Home Dock, and then turn this receiver
on again. If the message reappears, contact XM
Listener Care and explain the issue that you’re
experiencing and the corrective actions you’ve tried.
XM Power Error
A short-circuit occurring in the antenna or
surrounding antenna cable.
Make sure that there is nothing unusual with the
antenna or antenna cable. Switch the power off,
then back on again.
SIRIUS radio messages
Status messages
Antenna Error
Cause
Action
The SIRIUS antenna is not properly
Check that the antenna cable is attached securely.
connected.
Check Sirius Tuner
Acquiring Signal
The SiriusConnect™ tuner is not properly
connected.
Check that the 8 pin mini DIN cable and AC Adapter are
attached securely.
The SIRIUS signal is too weak at the current Check for antenna obstructions and reposition the
location.
SIRIUS antenna to get better signal reception. Use the
Antenna Aiming option to optimize the antenna position.
Subscription Updating
Updating Channels
Invalid Channel
Unit is updating subscription.
Wait until the channel subscription has been updated.
Wait until the channel information has been updated.
Select another channel.
Unit is updating the channel information.
Selected channel is not available/does not
exist.
Firmware Updating
The SiriusConnect™ tuner’s firmware is
Wait for updating to finish.
being updated.
If the problem is not solved after the troubleshooting above, if the screen freezes unexpectedly or if the buttons on the
remote control or front panel stop working completely, do the following:
• Press STANDBY/ON on the front panel to turn off the power, then turn the power back on.
• If the power cannot be turned off, press and hold STANDBY/ON on the front panel for over 10 seconds. The
power will turn off. (In this case, the various settings made on the receiver may be cleared.)
102
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
Surround sound formats
12
About THX
Below is a brief description of the main surround sound
formats you’ll find on BDs, DVDs, satellite, cable and
terrestrial broadcasts, and video cassettes.
The THX technologies are explained below. See
www.thx.com for more detailed information.
Dolby
The Dolby technologies are explained below. See
www.dolby.com for more detailed information.
•
THX Cinema processing
THX is an exclusive set of standards and technologies established by
THX Ltd. THX grew from George Lucas’ personal desire to make your
experience of the film soundtrack, in both movie theatres and in your
home theatre, as faithful as possible to what the director intended.
Movie soundtracks are mixed in special movie theatres called
dubbing stages and are designed to be played back in movie theatres
with similar equipment and conditions. This same soundtrack is then
transferred directly onto Laserdisc, VHS tape, DVD, etc., and is not
changed for playback in a small home theatre environment. THX
engineers developed patented technologies to accurately translate
the sound from the movie theatre environment into the home,
correcting the tonal and spatial errors that occur. On this product,
when the THX indicator is on, THX features are automatically added
in Cinema modes (e.g. THX Cinema, THX Surround EX).
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.
“Dolby”, “Pro Logic”, “Surround EX” and the double-D
symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
DTS
The DTS technologies are explained below. See
www.dtstech.com for more detailed information.
•
Re-Equalization
The tonal balance of a film soundtrack will be excessively bright and
harsh when played back over audio equipment in the home because
film soundtracks were designed to be played back in large movie
theaters using very different professional equipment. Re-Equalization
restores the correct tonal balance for watching a movie soundtrack in
a small home environment.
•
Timbre Matching
The human ear changes our perception of a sound depending on the
direction from which the sound is coming. In a movie theatre, there is
an array of surround speakers so that the surround information is all
around you. In a home theatre, you use only two speakers located to the
side of your head. The Timbre Matching feature filters the information
going to the surround speakers so that they more closely match the
tonal characteristics of the sound coming from the front speakers. This
ensures seamless panning between the front and surround speakers.
Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent #’s:
5,451,942; 5,956,674; 5,974,380; 5,978,762; 6,226,616;
6,487,535; 7,212,872; 7,333,929; 7,392,195; 7,272,567 &
other U.S. and worldwide patents issued & pending. DTS
and the Symbol are registered trademarks, & DTS-HD, DTS-
HD Master Audio, and the DTS logos are trademarks of
DTS, Inc. Product includes software. © DTS, Inc. All Rights
Reserved.
•
Adaptive Decorrelation
In a movie theatre, a large number of surround speakers help create
an enveloping surround sound experience, but in a home theatre
there are usually only two speakers. This can make the surround
speakers sound like headphones that lack spaciousness and
envelopment. The surround sounds will also collapse into the closest
speaker as you move away from the middle seating position. Adaptive
Decorrelation slightly changes one surround channel’s time and
phase relationship with respect to the other surround channel. This
expands the listening position and creates—with only two speakers—
the same spacious surround experience as in a movie theatre.
Windows Media Audio 9 Professional
Windows Media Audio 9 Professional (WMA9 Pro) is a
discrete surround format developed by Microsoft
Corporation.
•
THX Select2 Plus
Before any home theatre component can be THX Select2 Plus
certified, it must incorporate all the features above and also pass a
rigorous series of quality and performance tests. Only then can a
product feature the THX Select2 Plus logo, which is your guarantee
that the Home Theatre products you purchase will give you superb
performance for many years to come. THX Select2 Plus requirements
cover every aspect of the product including pre-amplifier and power
amplifier performance and operation, and hundreds of other
parameters in both the digital and analog domain.
Windows Media and the Windows logo are trademarks or
registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the
United States and/or other countries.
103
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
•
THX Surround EX
•
THX Select2 Music
THX Surround EX - Dolby Digital Surround EX is a joint development
of Dolby Laboratories and the THX Ltd. In a movie theater, film
soundtracks that have been encoded with Dolby Digital Surround EX
technology are able to reproduce an extra channel which has been
added during the mixing of the program. This channel, called
Surround Back, places sounds behind the listener in addition to the
currently available front left, front center, front right, surround right,
surround left and subwoofer channels. This additional channel
provides the opportunity for more detailed imaging behind the
listener and brings more depth, spacious ambience and sound
localization than ever before. Movies that were created using the
Dolby Digital Surround EX technology, when released into the home
consumer market may exhibit wording to that effect on the
packaging. A list of movies created using this technology can be
found on the Dolby web site at www.dolby.com.
For the playback of multi-channel music the THX Select2 Music mode
should be selected. In this mode THX ASA processing is applied to the
surround channels of all 5.1 encoded music sources such as DTS,
Dolby Digital and DVD-Audio to provide a wide stable rear
soundstage.
•
THX Select2 Games
For the playback of stereo and multi-channel game audio the THX
Select2 Games mode should be selected. In this mode THX ASA
processing is applied to the surround channels of all 5.1 and 2.0
encoded game sources such as analog, PCM, DTS and Dolby Digital.
This accurately places all game audio surround information,
providing a full 360 degree playback environment. THX Select2 Games
mode is unique as it gives you a smooth transition of audio in all
points of the surround field.
Only amplifier and controller products bearing the THX Surround EX
logo, when in the THX Surround EX mode, faithfully reproduce this
new technology in the home.
This product may also engage the “THX Surround EX” mode during
the playback of 5.1 channel material that is not Dolby Digital
Surround EX encoded. In such case the information delivered to the
Surround Back channel will be program dependent and may or may
not be very pleasing depending on the particular soundtrack and the
tastes of the individual listener.
THX, the THX logo and Select2 Plus are trademarks of THX Ltd. which
may be registered in some jurisdictions. All rights reserved. All other
trademarks are the property of their respective owners.
About iPod
•
Boundary Gain Compensation™
Depending on the listener’s and the subwoofer’s position, the listener
may experience an excessive bass effect. This feature compensates
for excessive bass resulting from a boundary gain effect. This feature
is designed to operate when used with a subwoofer certified to THX
Select2™ specifications.
“Made for iPod” means that an electronic accessory has
been designed to connect specifically to iPod and has
been certified by the developer to meet Apple
performance standards.
•
THX Loudness Plus Description
THX Loudness Plus is a new volume control technology featured in
THX Ultra2 Plus™ and THX Select2 Plus™ Certified amplifiers. With
THX Loudness Plus, home theater audiences can now experience the
rich details in a surround mix at any volume level. A consequence of
turning the volume below Reference Level is that certain sound
elements can be lost or perceived differently by the listener. THX
Loudness Plus compensates for the tonal and spatial shifts that occur
when the volume is reduced by intelligently adjusting ambient
surround channel levels and frequency response. This enables users
to experience the true impact of soundtracks regardless of the volume
setting. THX Loudness Plus is automatically applied when listening in
any THX listening mode. The new THX Cinema, THX Music, and THX
Games modes are tailored to apply the proper THX Loudness Plus
settings for each type of content.
“Works with iPhone” means that an electronic accessory
has been designed to connect specifically to iPhone and
has been certified by the developer to meet Apple
performance standards.
Apple is not responsible for the operation of this device or
its compliance with safety and regulatory standards.
iPod is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and
other countries.
iPhone is a trademark of Apple Inc.
•
THX Select2 Cinema
THX Select2 Cinema mode plays 5.1 movies using all 8 speakers
giving you the best possible movie watching experience. In this mode,
ASA processing blends the side surround speakers and back
surround speakers providing the optimal mix of ambient and
directional surround sounds.
DTS-ES (Matrix and 6.1 Discrete) and Dolby Digital Surround EX
encoded soundtracks will be automatically detected in Select2
Cinema mode if the appropriate flag has been encoded.
Some Dolby Digital Surround EX soundtracks are missing the digital
flag that allows automatic switching. If you know that the movie that
you are watching is encoded in Surround EX, you can manually select
the THX Surround EX playback mode, otherwise THX Select2 Cinema
mode will apply ASA processing to provide optimum replay.
104
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
About SIRIUS and XM
12
SIRIUS, XM and all related marks and logos are trademarks of Sirius
XM Radio Inc. and its subsidiaries. All other marks and logos are the
property of their respective owners. All rights reserved. SIRIUS and
XM subscriptions sold separately. Taxes and a one-time activation fee
may apply. XM tuners and home docks or SIRIUS tuners (each sold
separately) are required to receive the SIRIUS or XM satellite radio
service. All programming and fees subject to change. It is prohibited
to copy, decompile, disassemble, reverse engineer, hack, manipulate
or otherwise make available any technology or software incorporated
in receivers compatible with the SIRIUS or XM Satellite Radio
Systems. Service not available in Alaska and Hawaii.
SIRIUS, XM and all related marks and logos are trademarks of Sirius XM
Radio Inc. and its subsidiaries. All rights reserved. Service not available
in Alaska and Hawaii.
Record the SiriusConnect™ tuner ID below for reference.
Record the XM Radio ID below for reference.
Note: The XM Radio ID does not use the letters “I”, “O”, “S” or “F”.
105
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Auto Surround, ALC and Stream Direct with different input signal formats
The following charts show what you will hear with different input signal formats, depending on the Stream Direct mode (see
Using Stream Direct on page 55) you have selected.
Stereo (2 channel) signal formats
Input signal format
Surround Back speaker(s): Connected
Dolby Digital Surround
Auto Surround / ALC / DIRECT
PURE DIRECT
2 Pro Logic llx MOVIE
Neo:6 CINEMA
Stereo playback
As above
2 Pro Logic llx MOVIE
Neo:6 CINEMA
Stereo playback
ANALOG DIRECT (stereo)
PCM DIRECT
DTS Surround
Other stereo sources
Analog sources
PCM sources
As above
DVD-A sources
As above
As above
SACD sources
As above
As above
Surround Back speaker(s): Not connected
Dolby Digital Surround
2 Pro Logic ll MOVIE
Neo:6 CINEMA
Stereo playback
As above
2 Pro Logic ll MOVIE
Neo:6 CINEMA
Stereo playback
ANALOG DIRECT (stereo)
PCM DIRECT
DTS Surround
Other stereo sources
Analog sources
PCM sources
As above
DVD-A sources
SACD sources
As above
As above
As above
As above
Multichannel signal formats
Input signal format
Surround Back speaker(s): Connected
Dolby Digital EX (6.1 channel flagged)
Auto Surround / ALC
Dolby Digital EX
PURE DIRECT / DIRECT
Dolby Digital EX
a
a
2 Pro Logic llx MOVIE
2 Pro Logic llx MOVIE
DTS-ES (6.1 channel sources/6.1 channel flagged)
DTS sources (5.1 channel encoding)
DTS-HD sources
DTS-ES (Matrix/Discrete)
Straight decoding
As above
DTS-ES (Matrix/Discrete)
Straight decoding
As above
Other 5.1/6.1/7.1 channel sources
Surround Back speaker(s): Not connected
DVD-A sources/Multi-ch PCM
As above
As above
Straight decoding
As above
Straight decoding
As above
SACD sources (5.1 channel encoding)
Other 5.1/6.1/7.1 channel sources
As above
As above
a.Unavailable with only one surround back speaker connected.
106
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
Preset code list
12
You should have no problem controlling a component if you find the manufacturer in this list, but please note that there
are cases where codes for the manufacturer in the list will not work for the model that you are using. There are also
cases where only certain functions may be controllable after assigning the proper preset code.
Important
• We do not guarantee the operations of all the manufacturers and devices listed. Operation may not be possible
even if a preset code is entered.
If you can’t find a preset code that matches the component you want to control, you can still teach the remote
individual commands from another remote control (see Programming signals from other remote controls on
page 68).
example:
Category
TV
Pioneer 0004
Preset code
Manufacturer
TV
Pioneer 0004, 0006, 0113, 0115,
Curtis Mathes 0000, 0004, 0006,
0014, 0100, 0101
Hitachi 0004, 0006, 0007
Motorola 0003, 0014
0116, 0117, 0119, 0122, 0123
Hyundai 0098
MTC 0004, 0005, 0006, 0100
Multitech 0008, 0104, 0110
CXC 0008, 0104
Admiral 0001, 0014
Adventura 0012
Aiwa 0002
Ilo 0089, 0091
IMA 0008
Infinity 0101
InFocus 0074
Initial 0091
Insignia 0085, 0086
Inteq 0099
Janeil 0012
JBL 0101
JC Penney 0000, 0004, 0005, 0006,
0010
Cytron 0093
NAD 0006, 0102
NEC 0003, 0004, 0005, 0006, 0100
Net-TV 0107
Daewoo 0004, 0005, 0006, 0023
Daytron 0004, 0006
Dell 0073
DiamondVision 0096
Dimensia 0000
Disney 0046
Dumont 0004, 0011, 0099
Durabrand 0041, 0103, 0104
Dwin 0014
Akai 0002, 0100
Albatron 0097
Nikko 0006, 0100
Norcent 0060
Olevia 0048, 0054, 0059
Onwa 0008, 0104
Oppo 0095
Optimus 0105
Optoma 0075
Optonica 0014
Orion 0025
Panasonic 0003, 0010, 0017, 0027,
0105, 0114, 0120, 0121, 0124, 0125
Penney 0100, 0102
Philco 0003, 0004, 0005, 0006, 0007,
0100, 0101
Philips0003, 0004, 0007, 0019, 0020,
0101
Philips Magnavox 0019
Pilot 0004, 0100
Alleron 0009
America Action 0104
Amtron 0008
Anam 0104
Anam National 0003, 0008
AOC 0004, 0005, 0006, 0100
Apex 0021, 0102, 0106
Audiovox 0008, 0104
Aventura 0103
Electroband 0002
Electrograph 0107
Electrohome 0002, 0003, 0004,
0006
JCB 0002
Jensen 0004, 0006
JVC 0007, 0010, 0044, 5064
Axion 0094
Kawasho 0002, 0004, 0006
KEC 0104
Element 0082
Bang & Olufsen 0111
Belcor 0004
Emerson 0004, 0006, 0007, 0008,
0009, 0023, 0103, 0104
Emprex 0092
Kenwood 0004, 0006, 0100
KLH 0106
Bell & Howell 0001
Benq 0064
Kloss Novabeam 0008, 0012
KTV 0008, 0100, 0104, 0110
Envision 0004, 0006, 0100
Epson 0061
ESA 0103
Fujitsu 0009
Funai 0008, 0009, 0103, 0104
Futuretech 0008, 0104
Bradford 0008, 0104
Brillian 0109
LG 0005, 0052, 0078, 0097
Logik 0001
Luxman 0004, 0006
LXI 0000, 0006, 0101, 0102
Brockwood 0004
Broksonic 0104
Polaroid 0057, 0106
Portland 0004, 0005, 0006
Prima 0065
Candle 0004, 0006, 0012, 0100
Carnivale 0100
Magnavox 0004, 0006, 0019, 0020,
0037, 0042, 0100, 0101
Majestic 0001
Princeton 0097
Carver 0101
Gateway 0067, 0107, 0108
GE 0000, 0003, 0004, 0006, 0010,
0016, 0039
Prism 0010
CCE 0110
Proscan 0000
Celebrity 0002
Marantz 0004, 0006, 0062, 0100,
0101
Proton 0004, 0006, 0007
Protron 0055
Celera 0106
GFM 0080, 0084
Changhong 0106
Citizen 0004, 0006, 0008, 0100
Clarion 0104
Gibralter 0004, 0011, 0099, 0100
Goldstar 0004, 0005, 0006, 0007,
0100
Matsushita 0105
Proview 0068
Maxent 0087, 0107
Megapower 0097
Pulsar 0004, 0011, 0099
Gradiente 0066
Grunpy 0008, 0009, 0104
Haier 0112
Hallmark 0004, 0006
Harman/Kardon 0101
Harvard 0008, 0104
Havermy 0014
Hewlett Packard 0053
Hisense 0069
Coby 0056
Quasar 0003, 0010, 0105
Megatron 0006
Colortyme 0004, 0006
Concerto 0004, 0006
Contec 0104
Memorex 0001, 0005, 0006, 0041
MGA 0004, 0005, 0006, 0100
Midland 0010, 0011, 0099
Mintek 0091
Radio Shack 0100, 0104
Radio Shack/Realistic 0000, 0004,
0006, 0007, 0008
RCA 0000, 0003, 0004, 0005, 0006,
0013, 0024, 0035
Realistic 0100, 0104
Runco 0011, 0099, 0100
Contec/Cony 0007, 0008
Craig 0008, 0104
Crosley 0081, 0101
Crown 0008, 0104
CTX 0063
Mitsubishi 0004, 0005, 0006, 0014,
0045
Monivision 0097
Montgomery Ward 0001
Sampo 0004, 0006, 0100, 0107
107
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Samsung 0004, 0005, 0006, 0007,
0022, 0032, 0076, 0077, 0083, 0100,
0110
Sony 0002, 0018, 0029, 0030, 0031,
Syntax 0054
Vidtech 0004, 0005, 0006
Viewsonic 0058, 0107
Viking 0012
0034
Syntax-Brillian 0054
Soundesign 0004, 0006, 0008,
0009, 0104
Squareview 0103
SSS 0004, 0008, 0104
Starlite 0008, 0104
Superscan 0014
Supre-Macy 0012
Supreme 0002
SVA 0088
Sylvania 0004, 0006, 0049, 0079,
0080, 0100, 0101, 0103
Symphonic 0008, 0041, 0103, 0104
Tandy 0014
Tatung 0003, 0108
Sansui 0025
Viore 0089
Sanyo 0004, 0050
Vizio 0004, 0070, 0071, 0108
Technics 0010, 0105
Techwood 0004, 0006, 0010
Teknika 0001, 0004, 0005, 0006,
0007, 0008, 0009, 0101, 0104
TMK 0004, 0006
Sceptre 0072
Wards 0000, 0001, 0004, 0005, 0006,
Scotch 0006
0009, 0100, 0101
Scott 0004, 0006, 0007, 0008, 0009,
0090, 0104
Waycon 0102
Westinghouse 0047, 0051
White Westinghouse 0023
Sears 0000, 0004, 0006, 0009, 0101,
0102, 0103
TNCi 0099
Toshiba 0026, 0028, 0036, 0038,
Yamaha 0004, 0005, 0006, 0100
Zenith 0001, 0004, 0011, 0015, 0099
Sharp 0004, 0006, 0007, 0014, 0033
Sheng Chia 0014
0040, 0043, 0102
Vector Research 0100
Vidikron 0101
Shogun 0004
Signature 0001
DVD
If operations are not possible using the preset codes below, you may be able to conduct operations with the preset codes
for the BD, DVR (BDR, HDR).
Pioneer 2014, 2158
Denon 2026, 2068
Desay 2055
KLH 2070, 2080
Rowa 2071
Koss 2024, 2069, 2075
Accurian 2092
Advent 2072
Aiwa 2012
Akai 2066
Alco 2070
Samsung 2009, 2011, 2015, 2031,
DiamondVision 2042
Disney 2022
2044, 2068
Landel 2093
Lasonic 2085
Lenoxx 2074, 2090
LG 2019, 2051, 2061, 2082, 2087
Liquid Video 2075
Liteon 2025, 2092
Magnavox 2067, 2076, 2091
Memorex 2066
Microsoft 2077
Mintek 2038, 2080, 2086
Mitsubishi 2020
Nesa 2080
Next Base 2093
Nexxtech 2056
Onkyo 2076
Oppo 2041, 2057
Oritron 2069, 2075
Panasonic 2005, 2007, 2017, 2032,
2033, 2050, 2068, 2076
Philips 2045, 2076
Proceed 2079
Proscan 2077
Sansui 2066
Durabrand 2090
Sanyo 2066, 2083
Sharp 2035
Emerson 2067, 2082, 2091
Enterprise 2082
ESA 2053, 2091
Fisher 2083
Funai 2091
GE 2016, 2077, 2080
GFM 2043
Go Video 2087
Gradiente 2068
Greenhill 2080
Haier 2094
Harman/Kardon 2030, 2084
Hitachi 2011
Hiteker 2079
iLive 2062
Ilo 2038
Initial 2038, 2080
Insignia 2036, 2064, 2091
Integra 2078
Sherwood 2063
Allegro 2087
Amphion MediaWorks 2037
AMW 2037
Shinsonic 2086
Sonic Blue 2087
Sony 2003, 2004, 2010, 2012, 2027,
2046, 2047, 2048
Apex 2002, 2018, 2079, 2080
Apple 2058
Sungale 2054
Superscan 2067
Sylvania 2023, 2067, 2091
Symphonic 2023
Arrgo 2088
Aspire 2073
Astar 2052
Audiovox 2070
Axion 2040
Teac 2070
Technics 2068
Theta Digital 2078
Toshiba 2001, 2006, 2049, 2066,
2076
Bang & Olufsen 2081
Blaupunkt 2080
Blue Parade 2078
Boston 2059
Trutech 2000
Urban Concepts 2076
US Logic 2086
Venturer 2070
Xbox 2077
Yamaha 2005, 2068
Zenith 2019, 2076, 2082, 2087
Broksonic 2066
California Audio Labs 2068
CambridgeSoundWorks 2065
CineVision 2087
Coby 2029
iSymphony 2060
JBL 2084
JVC 2013
Kawasaki 2070
Kenwood 2028, 2068
Qwestar 2069
Curtis Mathes 2089
CyberHome 2000, 2088
Cytron 2039
RCA 2008, 2016, 2070, 2077, 2078,
2080
Regent 2074
Rio 2087
Daewoo 2021, 2087
BD
If operations are not possible using the preset codes below, you may be able to conduct operations with the preset codes
for the DVD, DVR (BDR, HDR).
Pioneer 2159, 2160
Kenwood 2044
LG 2123, 2124
Marantz 2139, 2140
Mitsubishi 2137, 2138
Onkyo 2126
Panasonic 2114, 2115, 2116
Philips 2117
Toshiba 2125, 2099
Yamaha 2134, 2135, 2136
Denon 2147, 2148, 2149
Hitachi 2144, 2145, 2146
JVC 2127, 2128, 2130, 2131, 2132,
2133
Samsung 2119
Sharp 2141, 2142, 2143
Sony 2120, 2121, 2122, 2129
DVR (BDR, HDR)
If operations are not possible using the preset codes below, you may be able to conduct operations with the preset codes
for the DVD, BD.
Pioneer 2103, 2150, 2151, 2152,
Sharp 2104, 2112
Sony 2105, 2108, 2109, 2110, 2113
Toshiba 2111
2153, 2154, 2155, 2156, 2157
Panasonic 2100, 2106
108
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
VCR
Pioneer 1035
ABS 1017
Adventura 1005
Aiwa 1005
Alienware 1017
American High 1004
Asha 1002
Audio Dynamics 1000
Audiovox 1003
Bang & Olufsen 1032
Beaumark 1002
Bell & Howell 1001
Calix 1003
Candle 1002, 1003
Canon 1004
Garrard 1005
Gateway 1017
GE 1002, 1004
GOI 1029
MGN Technology 1002
Microsoft 1017
Mind 1017
Sanky 1018
Sansui 1014, 1019
Sanyo 1001, 1002
Sears 1001, 1003, 1004
Sharp 1012
Mitsubishi 1010
Motorola 1004
MTC 1002
Goldstar 1000, 1003
Gradiente 1005
Shogun 1002
Singer 1004
Multitech 1002, 1005
Harley Davidson 1005
Harman/Kardon 1000
Headquarter 1001
Hewlett Packard 1017
HNS 1016
Howard Computers 1017
HP 1017
HTS 1029
Hughes Network Systems 1016,
1020, 1022, 1023, 1024
Humax 1016, 1020
Hush 1017
iBUYPOWER 1017
Instant Replay 1004
Sonic Blue 1026
Sony 1006, 1009, 1017, 1021
Stack 1017
NEC 1000, 1001
Nikko 1003
Niveus Media 1017
Noblex 1002
STS 1004
Sylvania 1004, 1005
Symphonic 1005
Systemax 1017
Northgate 1017
Olympus 1004
Optimus 1003
Orion 1014, 1019
Panasonic 1004, 1008
Philco 1004
Philips 1004, 1011, 1016, 1020, 1022,
1023, 1024, 1025
Philips Magnavox 1011
Pilot 1003
Proscan 1030
Pulsar 1018
Tagar Systems 1017
Tandy 1001
Citizen 1002, 1003
Colortyme 1000
Craig 1002, 1003
Curtis Mathes 1000, 1002, 1004
Cybernex 1002
Tashiko 1003
Teac 1005
Technics 1004
Teknika 1003, 1004, 1005
Tivo 1016, 1020, 1021, 1022, 1025
TMK 1002
JC Penney 1000, 1001, 1002, 1003,
CyberPower 1017
1004
JCL 1004
Daewoo 1005
Toshiba 1015, 1017, 1028
Totevision 1002, 1003
Touch 1017
UltimateTV 1031
Unitech 1002
Vector Research 1000
Video Concepts 1000
Videosonic 1002
Viewsonic 1017
Voodoo 1017
Wards 1002, 1003, 1004, 1005
XR-1000 1004, 1005
DBX 1000
JVC 1000, 1001, 1020, 1029
Quarter 1001
Quartz 1001
Quasar 1004
Dell 1017
Kenwood 1000, 1001
Kodak 1003, 1004
LG 1003
Linksys 1017
Lloyd’s 1005
LXI 1003
Magnavox 1004, 1018
Magnin 1003
Marantz 1000, 1001, 1004
Marta 1003
Matsushita 1004
Media Center PC 1017
MEI 1004
Memorex 1001, 1002, 1003, 1004,
1005, 1018, 1019
DIRECTV 1016, 1020, 1022, 1023,
1024, 1027, 1030, 1031
Dish Network 1029
Dishpro 1029
Radio Shack 1003
Radio Shack/Realistic 1001, 1002,
1003, 1004, 1005
Durabrand 1018
Dynatech 1005
Echostar 1029
Electrohome 1003
Electrophonic 1003
Emerson 1003, 1004, 1005
Expressvu 1029
Fisher 1001
Fuji 1004
Funai 1005
Radix 1003
Randex 1003
RCA 1002, 1004, 1007, 1016, 1020,
1022, 1030, 1031
Realistic 1001, 1002, 1003, 1004,
1005
Yamaha 1000, 1001
Zenith 1013, 1018
ZT Group 1017
ReplayTV 1026
Ricavision 1017
Runco 1018
Samsung 1002, 1016, 1022, 1024
Satellite Set Top Box
Pioneer 0126, 6097, 6098, 6145
Echostar 6002, 6089, 6036, 6005,
6003, 6004, 6146
McIntosh 6032
SEI 6139
Mitsubishi 6038
Motorola 6032, 6042
Siemens 6007, 6036
SKY 6042, 6059, 6030, 6031
SM Electronic 6011
Smart 6051
ADB 6035, 6001
Akai 6102
Expressvu 6002, 6004
Fujitsu 6133, 6134, 6135
Fortec Star 6123, 6023
Fresat 6014
Funai 6070
GE 6111
General Instrument 6032
GOI 6002, 6004
Grundig 6007, 6030
Alba 6005, 6013, 6011
Allsat 6102
NEC 6050, 6131
Netsat 6059
Sonicview 6055, 6107
Sony 6062, 6063, 6030, 6143
Star Choice 6032
Star Trak 6032
Alltech 6011
Next Level 6032
nfusion 6015
Amstrad 6033, 6030, 6044
Anttron 6013
Nokia 6025, 6026, 6118, 6119, 6121
Asat 6102
Austar 6000, 6045
Pace 6035, 6005, 6030, 6031
Panarex 6016
TechniSat 6033
Thomson 6110, 6111, 6014
Tivo 6113, 6114, 6115, 6116
Toshiba 6038, 6054, 6039, 6130
TPS 6041
BELL 6160
Bell ExpressVu 6002, 6003
British Sky Broadcasting 6030
Canal 6105
Chaparral 6034
CNS 6001
Coolsat 6021
Crossdigital 6043
Digenius 6104
Digiwave 6053
DirecTV 6070, 6110, 6111, 6062,
6063, 6113, 6008, 6038, 6054, 6069,
6060, 6059, 6043, 6018, 6114, 6115,
6116, 6093
Dish Network System 6002, 6089,
6003, 6004
Dishpro 6002, 6089, 6004
DX Antenna 6140
E Aichi 6141
Panasonic 6008, 6009, 6030, 6136,
6137, 6138
Hirschmann 6033
Hisense 6020
Pansat 6016, 6022
Philips 6002, 6113, 6038, 6054, 6060,
6059, 6102, 6103, 6030, 6114
Primestar 6032, 6147
Proscan 6110, 6111
Hitachi 6038, 6049, 6132
Houston 6002
Triasat 6033
Ultrasat 6021
US Digital 6020
USDTV 6020
ViewSat 6048
Voom 6032
HTS 6002, 6004
Hughes Network Systems 6113,
6038, 6054, 6114, 6115, 6116
Hyundai 6016
Proton 6020
RadioShack 6002, 6111, 6032
Radix 6036
iLo 6020
Innova 6059
Jerrold 6032, 6128, 6149, 6150,
6151, 6152, 6153, 6154, 6155, 6156,
6157
JVC 6002, 6003, 6004
Kathrein 6096
Lava 6053
LG 6047, 6018
Marantz 6102
RCA 6002, 6110, 6111, 6113, 6109,
Zehnder 6101
6061, 6114, 6142, 6144, 6148
Zenith 6042, 6069, 6037, 6125, 6127,
SA 6124, 6126, 6158, 6159
Saba 6014
Sagem 6041, 6120
Samsung 6070, 6113, 6091, 6043,
6017, 6114, 6093
Sanyo 6046
Sat Cruiser 6015
Schwaiger 6066
6129
109
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Satellite Set Top Box (SAT/PVR Combination)
Pioneer 0126, 0128
Bell ExpressVu 6002, 6003
DirecTV 6070, 6110, 6062, 6113,
6060, 6059, 6114, 6115, 6116
Dish Network System 6002, 6089
Dishpro 6002, 6089
Echostar 6002, 6089, 6003
Expressvu 6002
JVC 6003
Sonicview 6055, 6107
Sony 6062
Star Choice 6032
Tivo 6113, 6114, 6115, 6116
Motorola 6032
Philips 6113, 6114
Hughes Network Systems 6113, Proscan 6110
6114, 6115, 6116
Samsung 6114
Cable Set Top Box
Pioneer 6028, 6029, 6095, 6099
ABC 6122
Accuphase 6122
Amino 6077, 6078
Auna 6082
BCC 6072
Bell & Howell 6122
Bright House 6074, 6029
Cable One 6074, 6029
Cablevision 6074, 6029
Charter 6074, 6029, 6058
Cisco 6029, 6028, 6083
Comcast 6074, 6029, 1982
Cox 6074, 6029
Director 6073
Emerson 6122
Fosgate 6072
General Instrument 6073, 6072,
6122
Homecast 6024
i3 Micro 6077
Insight 6074, 6073, 6029
Jebsee 6122
Jerrold 6073, 6072, 6122
Knology 6029
Macab 6040
Mediacom 6074, 6029
Memorex 6112
Motorola 6074, 6073, 6072, 6029,
6122, 6094
Samsung 6095
Scientific Atlanta 6029, 6028,
6027, 6112
MTS 6094
Myrio 6077, 6078
Noos 6040
Sejin 6077
Shaw 6074
Starcom 6122
Pace 6074, 6029, 6028, 6106, 6083
Panasonic 6112, 6083
Paragon 6112
Stargate 6122
Suddenlink 6074, 6029
Supercable 6072
Penney 6112
Time Warner 6074, 6029, 6058
Tivo 6076
Toshiba 6112
United Cable 6072, 6122
US Electronics 6072
Videoway 6112
Zenith 6112
Philips 6012
Pulsar 6112
Quasar 6112
Regal 6072
Rogers 6029
Runco 6112
Digeo 6029, 6058
Cable Set Top Box (Cable/PVR Combination)
Pioneer 0127, 6029
Amino 6078
Bright House 6074, 6029
Cable One 6074, 6029
Cablevision 6074, 6029
Charter 6074, 6029, 6058
Cisco 6029, 6083
Mediacom 6074, 6029
Motorola 6074, 6081
Myrio 6078
Shaw 6074
Comcast 6074, 6029, 6083, 6076
Cox 6074, 6029
Suddenlink 6074, 6029
Supercable 6072
Time Warner 6074, 6029, 6058
Tivo 6076
Digeo 6081, 6058
Homecast 6024
Insight 6074, 6029
Knology 6029
Pace 6029
Panasonic 6083
Rogers 6029
Scientific Atlanta 6029
CD
Pioneer 5065, 5066
AKAI 5043
Asuka 5045
Denon 5019
Fisher 5048
Goldstar 5040
Hitachi 5042
Philips 5022, 5032, 5044
RCA 5013, 5029
Technics 5041
Victor 5014
Yamaha 5024, 5025, 5038, 5046,
5047
Kenwood 5020, 5021, 5031
Luxman 5049
Roadstar 5052
Marantz 5033
Onkyo 5017, 5018, 5030, 5050
Panasonic 5036
Sharp 5051
Sony 5012, 5023, 5026, 5027, 5028,
5039
TEAC 5015, 5016, 5034, 5035, 5037
CD-R
Pioneer 5067
Philips 5054
Yamaha 5055
Laser Disc Player
Pioneer 5062, 5063
Cassete Deck
Pioneer 5058, 5059, 5070
Digital Tape
Pioneer 5069
MD
Pioneer 5068
110
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
Specifications
12
Integrated Control Section
Control (SR) terminal . . . . . . . . . . . .Ø 3.5 Mini-jack (MONO)
Control (IR) terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . .Ø 3.5 Mini-jack (MONO)
IR signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . High Active (High Level: 2.0 V)
12 V Trigger terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . .Ø 3.5 Mini-jack (MONO)
12 V Trigger output type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 V, Total 150 mA
RS-232C cable type . . . . . . . 9-pin, cross type, female-female
EXTENSION terminal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 V, 150 mA
Amplifier Section
Continuous average power output of 140 watts* per
channel, min., at 8 ohms, from 20 Hz to 20 000 Hz
with no more than 0.08 %** total harmonic
distortion.
Multi channel simultaneous power output (1 kHz, 1 %, 8 Ω)
7 ch total . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 630 W
Continuous Power Output (20 Hz to 20 kHz, 8 Ω, 0.08 %)
Front. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 W + 140 W
Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 W
Surround . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 W + 140 W
Surround back (Front height/wide). . . . . . 140 W + 140 W
Continuous Power Output (1 kHz, 6 Ω, 1.0 %)
Network Section
LAN terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 BASE-T/100 BASE-TX
Miscellaneous
Power requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .AC 120 V, 60 Hz
Power consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330 W
In standby . . . . . . . .0.2 W (HDMI Setup – Control : OFF)
0.3 W (HDMI Setup – Control : ON)
Front. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 W + 180 W
Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 W
Surround . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 W + 180 W
Surround back (Front height/wide). . . . . . 180 W + 180 W
Total harmonic distortion. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.05 %
(20 Hz to 20 kHz, 130 W, 8 Ω)
* Measured pursuant to the Federal Trade Commission’s
Trade Regulation rule on Power Output Claims for Amplifiers
** Measured by Audio Spectrum Analyzer
Dimensions . . . . . .420 mm (W) x 200 mm (H) x 460 mm (D)
(16 9/16 in. (W) x 7 7/8 in. (H) x 18 1/8 in. (D))
Weight (without package). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18.5 kg (40.8 lb)
Number of Furnished Parts
MCACC Setup microphone (APM7009). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Remote control unit (AXD7591) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
AAA size IEC R03 dry cell batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
iPod cable. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
AM loop antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
FM wire antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Power cord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
These operating instructions
Audio Section
Input (Sensitivity/Impedance)
PHONO MM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 mV/47 kΩ
LINE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .400 mV/47 kΩ
Output (Level/Impedance)
REC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400 mV/2.2 kΩ
Signal-to-Noise Ratio (IHF, short circuited, A network)
LINE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 dB
Note
• Specifications and the design are subject to possible
modifications without notice, due to improvements.
Frequency Response . . . . . . . . . . . .5 Hz to 100 000 Hz dB
(Pure Direct Mode)
Tuner Section
Cleaning the unit
Frequency Range (FM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87.5 MHz to 108 MHz
Antenna Input (FM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Ω unbalanced
Frequency Range (AM). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531 kHz to 1602 kHz
Antenna (AM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Loop antenna (balanced)
• Use a polishing cloth or dry cloth to wipe off dust and
dirt.
• When the surface is dirty, wipe with a soft cloth
dipped in some neutral cleanser diluted five or six
times with water, and wrung out well, and then wipe
again with a dry cloth. Do not use furniture wax or
cleansers.
Video Section
Signal level
Composite Video. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Vp-p (75 Ω)
Component Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Y: 1.0 Vp-p (75 Ω),
PB, PR: 0.7 Vp-p (75 Ω)
Corresponding maximum resolution
Component Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1080p (1125p)
(Video convert off)
• Never use thinners, benzene, insecticide sprays or
other chemicals on or near this unit, since these will
corrode the surface.
®
This product includes FontAvenue fonts licenced by NEC corporation.
Digital In/Out Section
FontAvenue is a registered trademark of NEC Corporation
HDMI terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-pin (Not DVI)
HDMI output type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 V, 100 mA
USB terminal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . USB2.0 Full Speed (Type A)
iPod terminal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . USB, and Video (Composite)
SIRIUS antenna cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-pin mini DIN cable
ADAPTER PORT terminal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 V, 100 mA
111
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
112
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
113
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
114
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
PIONEER ELECTRONICS (USA) INC.
PIONEER ELECTRONICS OF CANADA, INC.
LIMITEDWARRANTY
WARRANTYVALIDONLYINCOUNTRYOFPRODUCTPURCHASE
WARRANTY
Pioneer Electronics (USA) Inc. (PUSA), and Pioneer Electronics Of Canada, Inc. (POC), warrant that products distributed by PUSA in the U.S.A., and by POC in Canada that fail to function
properlyundernormaluseduetoamanufacturingdefectwheninstalledandoperatedaccordingtotheowner’smanualenclosedwiththeunitwillberepairedorreplacedwithaunitofcomparable
value, at the option of PUSA or POC, without charge to you for parts or actual repair work. Parts supplied under this warranty may be new or rebuilt at the option of PUSA or POC.
THISLIMITEDWARRANTYAPPLIESTOTHEORIGINALORANYSUBSEQUENTOWNEROFTHISPIONEERPRODUCTDURINGTHEWARRANTYPERIODPROVIDEDTHE
PRODUCT WAS PURCHASED FROM AN AUTHORIZED PIONEER DISTRIBUTOR/DEALER IN THE U.S.A. OR CANADA. YOU WILL BE REQUIRED TO PROVIDE A SALES
RECEIPT OR OTHER VALID PROOF OF PURCHASE SHOWING THE DATE OF ORIGINAL PURCHASE OR, IF RENTED, YOUR RENTAL CONTRACT SHOWING THE PLACE
ANDDATEOFFIRSTRENTAL. INTHEEVENTSERVICEISREQUIRED,THEPRODUCTMUSTBEDELIVEREDWITHINTHEWARRANTYPERIOD,TRANSPORTATIONPREPAID,
ONLY FROM WITHIN THE COUNTRY OF PURCHASE AS EXPLAINED IN THIS DOCUMENT. YOU WILL BE RESPONSIBLE FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF THE
PRODUCT. PUSA OR POC, AS APPROPRIATE, WILL PAY TO RETURN THE REPAIRED OR REPLACEMENT PRODUCT TO YOU WITHIN THE COUNTRY OF PURCHASE.
Parts
Labor
PRODUCTWARRANTYPERIOD
1 Year
1 Year
Home Audio and Video
.........................................................................................................................................................
90 Days
90 Days
Microphones, Headphones, Phono Cartridges and Styluses ................................................................................................
Shorter limited warranty periods apply to some models. Please refer to the limited warranty document enclosed with the product for a definitive statement of the warranty period.
The warranty period for retail customers who rent the product commences upon the date product is first put into use (a) during the rental period or (b) retail sale, whichever occurs first.
WHAT IS NOT COVERED
IF THIS PRODUCT WAS PURCHASED FROM AN UNAUTHORIZED DISTRIBUTOR, THERE ARE NO WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING THE IMPLIED WARRANTY
OF MERCHANTABILITY AND THE IMPLIED WARRANTY OF FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND THIS PRODUCT IS SOLD STRICTLY “AS IS” AND “WITH ALL FAULTS".
PIONEER SHALL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY CONSEQUENTIAL AND/OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES.
PIONEER DOES NOT WARRANT ANY PRODUCT LISTED ABOVE WHEN IT IS USED IN A TRADE OR BUSINESS OR IN ANY INDUSTRIAL OR COMMERCIAL APPLICATION.
THIS WARRANTY DOES NOT APPLY IF THE PRODUCT HAS BEEN SUBJECTED TO POWER IN EXCESS OF ITS PUBLISHED POWER RATING.
THIS WARRANTY DOES NOT COVER TELEVISION OR DISPLAY SCREENS DAMAGED BY STATIC, NON-MOVING, IMAGES APPLIED FOR LENGTHY PERIODS (BURN-IN).
ANY
THISWARRANTYDOESNOTCOVERTHECABINETORANYAPPEARANCEITEM,USERATTACHEDANTENNA,ANYDAMAGETORECORDSORRECORDINGTAPESORDISCS,
DAMAGE TO THE PRODUCT RESULTING FROM ALTERATIONS, MODIFICATIONS NOT AUTHORIZED IN WRITING BY PIONEER, ACCIDENT, MISUSE OR ABUSE, DAMAGE DUE TO
LIGHTNINGORTOPOWERSURGES,SUBSEQUENTDAMAGEFROMLEAKING,DAMAGEFROMINOPERATIVEBATTERIES,ORTHEUSEOFBATTERIESNOTCONFORMINGTOTHOSE
SPECIFIED IN THE OWNER’S MANUAL.
THISWARRANTYDOESNOTCOVERTHECOSTOFPARTSORLABORWHICHWOULDBEOTHERWISEPROVIDEDWITHOUTCHARGEUNDERTHISWARRANTYOBTAINEDFROM
ANYSOURCEOTHERTHANAPIONEERAUTHORIZEDSERVICECOMPANYOROTHERDESIGNATEDLOCATION. THISWARRANTYDOESNOTCOVERDEFECTSORDAMAGECAUSED
BY THE USE OF UNAUTHORIZED PARTS OR LABOR OR FROM IMPROPER MAINTENANCE.
ALTERED, DEFACED, OR REMOVED SERIAL NUMBERS VOID THIS ENTIRE WARRANTY
NOOTHERWARRANTIES
IN THE U.S.A. - PIONEER LIMITS ITS OBLIGATIONS UNDER ANY IMPLIED WARRANTIES INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITYANDFITNESSFORAPARTICULARPURPOSE,TOAPERIODNOTTOEXCEEDTHEWARRANTYPERIOD. NOWARRANTIESSHALLAPPLYAFTERTHE
WARRANTYPERIOD. SOMESTATESDONOTALLOWLIMITATIONSONHOWLONGANIMPLIEDWARRANTYLASTSANDSOMESTATESDONOTALLOWTHEEXCLUSIONS
ORLIMITATIONSOFINCIDENTALORCONSEQUENTIALDAMAGES, SOTHEABOVELIMITATIONSOREXCLUSIONSMAYNOTAPPLYTOYOU. THISWARRANTYGIVES
YOU SPECIFIC LEGAL RIGHTS AND YOU MAY HAVE OTHER RIGHTS WHICH MAY VARY FROM STATE TO STATE.
INCANADA-EXCEPTASEXPRESSLYPROVIDEDHEREIN,THEREARENOREPRESENTATIONS,WARRANTIES,OBLIGATIONSORCONDITIONS,IMPLIED,STATUTORY
OR OTHERWISE, APPLICABLE TO THIS PRODUCT.
TO OBTAIN SERVICE
PUSA and POC have appointed a number of Authorized Service Companies throughout the U.S.A. and Canada should your product require service. To receive warranty service
you need to present your sales receipt or, if rented, your rental contract showing place and date of original owner’s transaction. If shipping the unit you will need to package
it carefully and send it, transportation prepaid by a traceable, insured method, to an Authorized Service Company. Package the product using adequate padding material to
prevent damage in transit. The original container is ideal for this purpose. Include your name, address and telephone number where you can be reached during business hours.
On all complaints and concerns in the U.S.A. call Customer Support at 1-800-421-1404, or, in Canada, call Customer Satisfaction at 1-877-283-5901.
INCANADA
For additional information on this warranty,
please call or write:
INTHEU.S.A.
For hook-up and operation of your unit or to locate an
Authorized Service Company, please call or write:
CUSTOMERSATISFACTIONGROUP
PIONEERELECTRONICSOFCANADA,INC.
300 ALLSTATE PARKWAY
MARKHAM, ON L3R 0P2
PIONEERELECTRONICSSERVICE,INC.
P.O. BOX 1760
LONG BEACH, CALIFORNIA 90801
1-800-421-1404
(905) 479-4411
1-877-283-5901
http://www.pioneerelectronics.ca
http://www.pioneerelectronics.com
DISPUTERESOLUTION
IN THE U.S.A. - Following our response to any initial request to Customer Support, should a dispute arise between you and Pioneer, Pioneer makes available its Complaint
Resolution Program to resolve the dispute. The Complaint Resolution Program is available to you without charge. You are required to use the Complaint Resolution Program
before you exercise any rights under, or seek any remedies, created by Title I of the Magnuson-Moss Warranty-Federal Trade Commission Improvement Act, 15 U.S.C. 2301 et seq.
To use the Complaint Resolution Program call 1-800-421-1404 and explain to the customer service representative the problem you are experiencing, steps you have taken
to have the product repaired during the warranty period and the name of the authorized Distributor/Dealer from whom the Pioneer product was purchased. After the complaint
has been explained to the representative, a resolution number will be issued. Within 40 days of receiving your complaint, Pioneer will investigate the dispute and will either:
(1) respond to your complaint in writing informing you what action Pioneer will take, and in what time period, to resolve the dispute; or (2) respond to your complaint in writing
informing you why it will not take any action.
IN CANADA - Call the Customer Satisfaction Manager at (905) 946-7446 to discuss your complaint and to obtain a prompt resolution.
RECORDTHEPLACEANDDATEOFPURCHASEFORFUTUREREFERENCE
ModelNo. ____________________________________________ SerialNo. _________________________________________ PurchaseDate _______________________
PurchasedFrom _______________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________
KEEP THIS INFORMATION AND YOUR SALES RECEIPT IN A SAFE PLACE
115
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
To register your product, find the nearest authorized service location, to
purchase replacement parts, operating instructions, or accessories,
please go to one of following URLs :
Pour enregistrer votre produit, trouver le service après-vente agréé le plus
proche et pour acheter des pièces de rechange, des modes d’emploi ou
des accessoires, reportez-vous aux URL suivantes :
In the USA/Aux Etats-Unis
http://www.pioneerelectronics.com
In Canada/Aux Canada
http://www.pioneerelectronics.ca
S018_B1_EnFr
PIONEER CORPORATION
1-1, Shin-ogura, Saiwai-ku, Kawasaki-shi, Kanagawa 212-0031, Japan
PIONEER ELECTRONICS (USA) INC.
P.O. BOX 1540, Long Beach, California 90801-1540, U.S.A. TEL: (800) 421-1404
PIONEER ELECTRONICS OF CANADA, INC.
300 Allstate Parkway, Markham, Ontario L3R 0P2, Canada TEL: 1-877-283-5901, 905-479-4411
PIONEER EUROPE NV
Haven 1087, Keetberglaan 1, B-9120 Melsele, Belgium TEL: 03/570.05.11
PIONEER ELECTRONICS ASIACENTRE PTE. LTD.
253 Alexandra Road, #04-01, Singapore 159936 TEL: 65-6472-7555
PIONEER ELECTRONICS AUSTRALIA PTY. LTD.
178-184 Boundary Road, Braeside, Victoria 3195, Australia, TEL: (03) 9586-6300
PIONEER ELECTRONICS DE MEXICO S.A. DE C.V.
Blvd.Manuel Avila Camacho 138 10 piso Col.Lomas de Chapultepec, Mexico, D.F. 11000 TEL: 55-9178-4270
K002_B1_En
Published by Pioneer Corporation.
Copyright © 2010 Pioneer Corporation.
All rights reserved.
<ARB7447-B>
Printed in
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
|